blob: c0b04bfb9c8406683a0e6bf1a8ffaad209014930 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau37242fa2010-08-28 19:21:00 +02007 2010/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -d
421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 * Performance tuning
448 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100449 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - noepoll
451 - nokqueue
452 - nopoll
453 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200455 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200456 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200457 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100458 - tune.maxaccept
459 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100461 - tune.rcvbuf.client
462 - tune.rcvbuf.server
463 - tune.sndbuf.client
464 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Debugging
467 - debug
468 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469
470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004713.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472------------------------------------
473
474chroot <jail dir>
475 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
476 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
477 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
478 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
479 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
480 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200482daemon
483 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
484 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
485 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
486
487gid <number>
488 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
489 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
490 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
491 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493group <group name>
494 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
495 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100496
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200497log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
499 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100500 configured with "log global".
501
502 <address> can be one of:
503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100504 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100505 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
506 port).
507
508 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
509 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
510 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
511 writeable).
512
513 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200514
515 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
516 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
517 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
518
519 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200520 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
521 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
522 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
523 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
524 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
525 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
528
529nbproc <number>
530 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
531 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
532 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
533 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
534 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
535
536pidfile <pidfile>
537 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
538 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
539 starting the process. See also "daemon".
540
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200541stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200542 [level <level>]
543
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200544 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
545 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100546 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200547 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
548
549 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
550 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
551 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
552 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
553 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
554
555 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
556 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
557 counters).
558
559 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
560 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100561
562 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
563 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
564 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
565 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
566 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
567 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
568 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200569
570stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
571 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
572 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100573 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200574
575stats maxconn <connections>
576 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
577 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579uid <number>
580 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
581 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
582 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
583 one. See also "gid" and "user".
584
585ulimit-n <number>
586 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
587 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
588 option.
589
590user <user name>
591 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
592 See also "uid" and "group".
593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200594node <name>
595 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
596
597 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
598 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
599 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
600 traffic.
601
602description <text>
603 Add a text that describes the instance.
604
605 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
606 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
607 "<" and ">" characters.
608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611-----------------------
612
613maxconn <number>
614 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
615 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
616 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
617 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619maxpipes <number>
620 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
621 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
622 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
623 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
624 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
625 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627noepoll
628 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
629 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
630 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
631
632nokqueue
633 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
634 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
635 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
636
637nopoll
638 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
639 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100640 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
642 "nokqueue".
643
644nosepoll
645 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
646 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
647 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
648
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649nosplice
650 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
651 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
652 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100653 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100654 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
655 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
656 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
657 "option splice-response".
658
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200659spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
660 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
661 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
662 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
663 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
664 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
665
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666tune.bufsize <number>
667 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
668 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
669 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
670 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
671 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
672 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
673 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
674 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
675
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676tune.chksize <number>
677 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
678 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
679 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
680 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
681 checks whenever possible.
682
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683tune.maxaccept <number>
684 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
685 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
686 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100687 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
689 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100690 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
692
693tune.maxpollevents <number>
694 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
695 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
696 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
697 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
698 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
699
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200700tune.maxrewrite <number>
701 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
702 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
703 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
704 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
705 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
706 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
707 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
708 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
709 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
710 bufsize.
711
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100712tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
713tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
714 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
715 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
716 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
717 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
718 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
719 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
720 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
721
722tune.sndbuf.client <number>
723tune.sndbuf.server <number>
724 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
725 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
726 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
727 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
728 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
729 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
730 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
731 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
732 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
733 notifying haproxy again.
734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007363.3. Debugging
737--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738
739debug
740 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
741 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
742 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
743 system startup.
744
745quiet
746 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
747 line argument "-q".
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007493.4. Userlists
750--------------
751It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
752http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
753it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
754
755userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100756 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100757 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
758
759group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100760 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100761 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
762 proceeded by "users" keyword.
763
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100764user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
765 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100766 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
767 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100768 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
769 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100770 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
771 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
772
773
774 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100775 userlist L1
776 group G1 users tiger,scott
777 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100778
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100779 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
780 user scott insecure-password elgato
781 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100783 userlist L2
784 group G1
785 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100786
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100787 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
788 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
789 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100790
791 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
797 - defaults <name>
798 - frontend <name>
799 - backend <name>
800 - listen <name>
801
802A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
803its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
804section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100805section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200806
807A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
808connections.
809
810A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
811to forward incoming connections.
812
813A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
814parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100816All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
817'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
818case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
819
820Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
821logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
822proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
823However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
824name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
825
826Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
827and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100828bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100829protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
830modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
831arbitrary criteria.
832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008344.1. Proxy keywords matrix
835--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200837The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
838limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
839they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
840limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100841marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200842option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200843and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
844with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
845specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100848 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
849------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
850acl - X X X
851appsession - - X X
852backlog X X X -
853balance X - X X
854bind - X X -
855bind-process X X X X
856block - X X X
857capture cookie - X X -
858capture request header - X X -
859capture response header - X X -
860clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
861contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
862cookie X - X X
863default-server X - X X
864default_backend X X X -
865description - X X X
866disabled X X X X
867dispatch - - X X
868enabled X X X X
869errorfile X X X X
870errorloc X X X X
871errorloc302 X X X X
872-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
873errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200874force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100875fullconn X - X X
876grace X X X X
877hash-type X - X X
878http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100879http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200880http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100881http-request - X X X
882id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200883ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100884log X X X X
885maxconn X X X -
886mode X X X X
887monitor fail - X X -
888monitor-net X X X -
889monitor-uri X X X -
890option abortonclose (*) X - X X
891option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
892option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
893option allbackups (*) X - X X
894option checkcache (*) X - X X
895option clitcpka (*) X X X -
896option contstats (*) X X X -
897option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
898option dontlognull (*) X X X -
899option forceclose (*) X X X X
900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
901option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200902option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100903option http-server-close (*) X X X X
904option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
905option httpchk X - X X
906option httpclose (*) X X X X
907option httplog X X X X
908option http_proxy (*) X X X X
909option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200910option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100911option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
912option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
913option logasap (*) X X X -
914option mysql-check X - X X
915option nolinger (*) X X X X
916option originalto X X X X
917option persist (*) X - X X
918option redispatch (*) X - X X
919option smtpchk X - X X
920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
922option splice-request (*) X X X X
923option splice-response (*) X X X X
924option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
925option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
927option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
928option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
929option tcpka X X X X
930option tcplog X X X X
931option transparent (*) X - X X
932persist rdp-cookie X - X X
933rate-limit sessions X X X -
934redirect - X X X
935redisp (deprecated) X - X X
936redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
937reqadd - X X X
938reqallow - X X X
939reqdel - X X X
940reqdeny - X X X
941reqiallow - X X X
942reqidel - X X X
943reqideny - X X X
944reqipass - X X X
945reqirep - X X X
946reqisetbe - X X X
947reqitarpit - X X X
948reqpass - X X X
949reqrep - X X X
950-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
951reqsetbe - X X X
952reqtarpit - X X X
953retries X - X X
954rspadd - X X X
955rspdel - X X X
956rspdeny - X X X
957rspidel - X X X
958rspideny - X X X
959rspirep - X X X
960rsprep - X X X
961server - - X X
962source X - X X
963srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200964stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100965stats auth X - X X
966stats enable X - X X
967stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200968stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969stats realm X - X X
970stats refresh X - X X
971stats scope X - X X
972stats show-desc X - X X
973stats show-legends X - X X
974stats show-node X - X X
975stats uri X - X X
976-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
977stick match - - X X
978stick on - - X X
979stick store-request - - X X
980stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200981tcp-request connection - X X -
982tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200983tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100984timeout check X - X X
985timeout client X X X -
986timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
987timeout connect X - X X
988timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
989timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
990timeout http-request X X X X
991timeout queue X - X X
992timeout server X - X X
993timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
994timeout tarpit X X X X
995transparent (deprecated) X - X X
996use_backend - X X -
997------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
998 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010014.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1002---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001003
1004This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1005
1006
1007acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1008 Declare or complete an access list.
1009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1010 no | yes | yes | yes
1011 Example:
1012 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1013 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1014 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001016 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001017
1018
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001019appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1020 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001021 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1023 no | no | yes | yes
1024 Arguments :
1025 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1026 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1027
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001028 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029 checked in each cookie value.
1030
1031 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1032 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1033 milliseconds.
1034
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001035 request-learn
1036 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1037 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1038 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1039 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1040 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1041 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001043 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1044 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1045 data following this prefix.
1046
1047 Example :
1048 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1049
1050 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1051 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1052
1053 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1054 2 modes are currently supported :
1055 - path-parameters :
1056 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1057 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1058 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1059 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1060 - query-string :
1061 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1062 query string.
1063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001064 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1065 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1066 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1067 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001068 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1069 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1070 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001071 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1072 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1073
1074 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1075
1076 Example :
1077 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1078
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001079 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001080 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001081
1082
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001083backlog <conns>
1084 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1086 yes | yes | yes | no
1087 Arguments :
1088 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1089 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1090 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1091
1092 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1093 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1094 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1095 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1096 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1097 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1098 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1099 backlog parameter.
1100
1101 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1102 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1103 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1104
1105 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1106
1107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001109balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001110 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1112 yes | no | yes | yes
1113 Arguments :
1114 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1115 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1116 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1117 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1118
1119 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1120 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1121 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1122 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001123 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1124 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1125 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1126 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1127 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1128 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1129 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1130 it, so that you don't worry.
1131
1132 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1133 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1134 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1135 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1136 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1137 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1138 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1139 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001141 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1142 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1143 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1144 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1145 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1146 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1147 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1148 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1151 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1152 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1153 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1154 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1155 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1156 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1157 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001158 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001160 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1161 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1162 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001163
1164 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1165 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1166 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1167 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1168 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1169 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1170 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001171 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1172 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1173 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001174
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001175 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1176 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1177 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1178 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1179 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1180 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1181 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1182 URIs start with a leading "/".
1183
1184 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1185 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1186 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1187 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1188
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001190 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1191
1192 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1193 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1194 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1195 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1196 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1197 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1198 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1199 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1200 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1201 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1202 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1203 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1204 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1205 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1206 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1207 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1208 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1209 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1210 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1211 be randomly balanced if at all.
1212
1213 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1214 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1215 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1216 server will receive the request.
1217
1218 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1219 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1220 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1221 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1222 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001223 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1224 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1225 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001226
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001227 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1228 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1229 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001230 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001231 algorithm is applied instead.
1232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001233 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001234 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1235 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1236 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1237
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001238 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1239 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1240 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1241
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001242 rdp-cookie
1243 rdp-cookie(name)
1244 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1245 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1246 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1247 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1248 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1249 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001250 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001251 used instead.
1252
1253 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1254 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1255 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1256 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1257
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001258 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1259 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1260 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001263 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1264 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001265
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001266 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001267 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001268
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001269 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1270 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1271 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001272
1273 Examples :
1274 balance roundrobin
1275 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001276 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001277 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1278 balance hdr(host)
1279 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001280
1281 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1282 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001284 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001285 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1286 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1287 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1288 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1289
1290 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1291 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1292 defaults to 16 kB.
1293
1294 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1295 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1296
1297 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1298 Round Robin.
1299
1300 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1301 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1302 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1303 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1304
1305 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1306
1307 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001309 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1310 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1311 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001312
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001313 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1314 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001315
1316
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001317bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1318bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1319bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1320bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1321bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1322bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1323bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001324 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1326 no | yes | yes | no
1327 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001328 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1329 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1330 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1331 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1332 special address "0.0.0.0".
1333
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001334 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1335 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
1336 above. The port is mandatory. Note that in the case of an
1337 IPv6 address, the port is always the number after the last
1338 colon (':'). A range can either be :
1339 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1340 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1341 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1342 the range.
1343
1344 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1345 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1346 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1347 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1348 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1349 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1350 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1351 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1352 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001354 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1355 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1356 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1357 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1358 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1359 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1360 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1361 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
1362 privileges.
1363
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001364 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1365 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1366 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1367 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1368 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1369 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1370 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1371 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
1372
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001373 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1374 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1375 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1376 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001377
1378 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1379
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001380 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1381 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1382 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001383 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001384 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1385 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1386 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1387 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
1388 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001390 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001391 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1392 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1393 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1394 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1395 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1396 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1397 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1398 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1399 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1400 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1401 with front firewalls which would see an established
1402 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1405 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1406 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1407 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1408 in a frontend.
1409
1410 Example :
1411 listen http_proxy
1412 bind :80,:443
1413 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
1414
1415 See also : "source".
1416
1417
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001418bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1419 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1421 yes | yes | yes | yes
1422 Arguments :
1423 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1424 may be used to override a default value.
1425
1426 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1427 option may be combined with other numbers.
1428
1429 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1430 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1431 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1432 missing from all processes.
1433
1434 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1435 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1436 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1437 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1438
1439 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1440 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1441 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1442 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1443 and 'even' instances.
1444
1445 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1446 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1447 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1448 32.
1449
1450 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1451 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1452
1453 Example :
1454 listen app_ip1
1455 bind 10.0.0.1:80
1456 bind_process odd
1457
1458 listen app_ip2
1459 bind 10.0.0.2:80
1460 bind_process even
1461
1462 listen management
1463 bind 10.0.0.3:80
1464 bind_process 1 2 3 4
1465
1466 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1467
1468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469block { if | unless } <condition>
1470 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473
1474 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1475 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001476 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1478 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1479 "block" statements per instance.
1480
1481 Example:
1482 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1483 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1484 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1485 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488
1489
1490capture cookie <name> len <length>
1491 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | yes | yes | no
1494 Arguments :
1495 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1496 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1497 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1498 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1499 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1500
1501 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1502 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1503 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1504 right if it exceeds <length>.
1505
1506 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1507 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1508 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1509 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1510
1511 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1512 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1513 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1514
1515 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1516 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1517 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1518 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001519 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1521
1522 Example:
1523 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1524
1525 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001526 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527
1528
1529capture request header <name> len <length>
1530 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1532 no | yes | yes | no
1533 Arguments :
1534 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001535 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1537 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1538 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1539
1540 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1541 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1542 it exceeds <length>.
1543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001544 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1546 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001547 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1548 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1549 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1550 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001551 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001552 environments to find where the request came from.
1553
1554 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1555 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1556 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1557 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001558
1559 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1560 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1561 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1562 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1563
1564 Example:
1565 capture request header Host len 15
1566 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1567 capture request header Referrer len 15
1568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001569 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 about logging.
1571
1572
1573capture response header <name> len <length>
1574 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1576 no | yes | yes | no
1577 Arguments :
1578 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001579 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1581 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1582 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1583
1584 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1585 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1586 it exceeds <length>.
1587
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001588 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001589 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1590 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1591 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001592 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1593 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1594 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1595 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001596
1597 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1598 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1599 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1600 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1601
1602 Example:
1603 capture response header Content-length len 9
1604 capture response header Location len 15
1605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001606 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607 about logging.
1608
1609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001610clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1613 yes | yes | yes | no
1614 Arguments :
1615 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1617 as explained at the top of this document.
1618
1619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1620 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1621 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1622 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1623 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1624 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1625 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1626 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001627 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1629 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1630
1631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1637
1638 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1639 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1640
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1642 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
1644
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001645contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1648 yes | no | yes | yes
1649 Arguments :
1650 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1651 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1652 as explained at the top of this document.
1653
1654 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001655 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001656 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1658 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1659 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1660 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1661
1662 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1663 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1664 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1665 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1666 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1667 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1668
1669 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1670 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1671 instead.
1672
1673 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1674 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1675
1676
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001677cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001678 [ postonly ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001679 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001680 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1682 yes | no | yes | yes
1683 Arguments :
1684 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1685 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1686 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1687 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1688 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1689 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1690 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1691 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1692 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1693
1694 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1695 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1696 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1697 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1698 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1699 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1700 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1701 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1702 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1703 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1704 "insert" and "prefix".
1705
1706 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001707 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
1708 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
1709 server. If the server emits a cookie with the same name, it will
1710 be remove before processing. For this reason, this mode can be
1711 used to upgrade existing configurations running in the "rewrite"
1712 mode. The cookie will only be a session cookie and will not be
1713 stored on the client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect"
1714 option is added, the server will see the cookies emitted by the
1715 client. Due to caching effects, it is generally wise to add the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001716 "nocache" or "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert"
1717 keyword is not compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
1718
1719 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1720 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1721 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1722 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1723 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1724 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1725 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1726 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1727 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1728 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1729 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1730
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001731 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1732 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1733 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
1734 it will be removed. In "insert" mode, this will additionally
1735 remove cookies from requests transmitted to the server, making
1736 the persistence mechanism totally transparent from an application
1737 point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738
1739 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1740 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1741 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1742 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1743 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1744 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1745 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1746 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1747 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1748
1749 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1750 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1751 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1752 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1753 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1754 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1755 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1756 persistence cookie in the cache.
1757 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001759 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001760 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001761 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1762 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1763 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1764 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1765 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1766 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001767
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001768 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1769 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1770 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1771 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1772 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1773 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1774 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1775 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1776 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1777 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1778 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1779 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1780 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1781 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1782 the site.
1783
1784 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1785 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1786 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1787 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1788 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1789 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1790 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1791 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1792 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1793 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1794 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1795 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1796 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1797 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1798 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1799 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1800
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1802 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1803 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1804 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 Examples :
1807 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1808 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1809 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001810 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001812 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001813 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001816default-server [param*]
1817 Change default options for a server in a backend
1818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1819 yes | no | yes | yes
1820 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001821 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1822 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1823 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1824 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001825
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001826 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001827 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1828
1829 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832default_backend <backend>
1833 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1835 yes | yes | yes | no
1836 Arguments :
1837 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1838
1839 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1840 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1841 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1842 will catch all undetermined requests.
1843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 Example :
1845
1846 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1847 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1848 default_backend dynamic
1849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001850 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852
1853disabled
1854 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1856 yes | yes | yes | yes
1857 Arguments : none
1858
1859 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1860 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
1861 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
1862 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
1863 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
1864 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
1865 keyword in a "defaults" section.
1866
1867 See also : "enabled"
1868
1869
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02001870dispatch <address>:<port>
1871 Set a default server address
1872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1873 no | no | yes | yes
1874 Arguments : none
1875
1876 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
1877 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
1878 during start-up.
1879
1880 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
1881 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
1882 possible with normal servers.
1883
1884 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
1885 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
1886 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
1887 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
1888 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
1889
1890 See also : "server"
1891
1892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001893enabled
1894 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1896 yes | yes | yes | yes
1897 Arguments : none
1898
1899 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
1900 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
1901
1902 See also : "disabled"
1903
1904
1905errorfile <code> <file>
1906 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1908 yes | yes | yes | yes
1909 Arguments :
1910 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1911 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1912
1913 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001914 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001916 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
1917 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918
1919 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1920 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1921 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1922
1923 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
1924 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
1925 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
1926 files returning the same contents as default errors.
1927
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001928 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
1929 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
1930 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
1931 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
1932 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
1933 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
1934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001935 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
1936 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
1937 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01001938 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
1940
1941 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
1942
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001943 Example :
1944 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
1945 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
1946 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
1947
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001948
1949errorloc <code> <url>
1950errorloc302 <code> <url>
1951 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 yes | yes | yes | yes
1954 Arguments :
1955 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1956 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1957
1958 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1959 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1960 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1961 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1962 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1963
1964 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1965 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1966 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1967
1968 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
1969 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
1970 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
1971 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
1972 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
1973 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
1974 request.
1975
1976 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
1977
1978
1979errorloc303 <code> <url>
1980 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1982 yes | yes | yes | yes
1983 Arguments :
1984 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1985 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1986
1987 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1988 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1989 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1990 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1991 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1992
1993 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1994 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1995 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1996
1997 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
1998 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
1999 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2000 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002001 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002002
2003 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2004
2005
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002006force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2007 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2009 no | yes | yes | yes
2010
2011 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2012 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2013 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2014 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2015 marked down for maintenance operations.
2016
2017 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2018 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2019 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2020 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2021 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2022 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2023 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2024 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2025 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2026
2027 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2028 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2029 is used.
2030
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002031 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002032 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002033
2034
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002035fullconn <conns>
2036 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2038 yes | no | yes | yes
2039 Arguments :
2040 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2041 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2042
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002043 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002044 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002045 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002046 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2047 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2048 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2049 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2050 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002051 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002052
2053 Example :
2054 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2055 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2056 # connections.
2057 backend dynamic
2058 fullconn 10000
2059 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2060 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2061
2062 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2063
2064
2065grace <time>
2066 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002068 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002069 Arguments :
2070 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2071 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2072 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2073
2074 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2075 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002076 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002077 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2078
2079 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2080 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2081 simplify it.
2082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002084hash-type <method>
2085 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2087 yes | no | yes | yes
2088 Arguments :
2089 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2090 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2091 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2092 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2093 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2094 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2095 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2096 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2097 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2098
2099 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2100 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2101 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2102 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2103 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2104 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2105 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2106 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2107 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2108 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2109 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2110 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2111 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2112
2113 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2114
2115 See also : "balance", "server"
2116
2117
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002118http-check disable-on-404
2119 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002121 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122 Arguments : none
2123
2124 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2125 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2126 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2127 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2128 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2129 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2130 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2131 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002132 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2133 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2134 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2135
2136 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2137
2138
2139http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2140 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2142 no | no | yes | yes
2143 Arguments :
2144 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2145 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2146 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2147 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2148 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2149 details on the supported keywords.
2150
2151 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2152 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2153 with the usual backslash ('\').
2154
2155 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2156 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2157 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2158 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2159 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2160
2161 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2162 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2163 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2164 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2165 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2166
2167 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2168 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2169 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2170 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2171 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2172 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2173
2174 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2175 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2176 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2177 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2178 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2179 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2180 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2181 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2182 trace).
2183
2184 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2185 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2186 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2187 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2188 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2189 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2190 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2191 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2192
2193 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2194 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2195 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2196 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2197 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2198 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2199 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2200 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2201
2202 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2203 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2204
2205 Examples :
2206 # only accept status 200 as valid
2207 http-request expect status 200
2208
2209 # consider SQL errors as errors
2210 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2211
2212 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2213 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2214
2215 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2216 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002218 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002219
2220
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002221http-check send-state
2222 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2224 yes | no | yes | yes
2225 Arguments : none
2226
2227 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2228 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2229 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2230 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2231 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2232
2233 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2234 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2235 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2236 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2237 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2238 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2239 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2240 checked in multiple backends.
2241
2242 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2243 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2244
2245 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2246 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2247 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2248 one fails.
2249
2250 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2251 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2252 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2253
2254 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2255 server's queue.
2256
2257 Example of a header received by the application server :
2258 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2259 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2260
2261 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2262
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002263http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002264 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002265 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2266
2267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2268 no | yes | yes | yes
2269
2270 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2271 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2272 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002273 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2274 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002275 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2276
2277 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2278 instance.
2279
2280 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002281 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2282 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2283 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002284
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002285 http-request allow if nagios
2286 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2287 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2288 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002289
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002290 Example:
2291 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002292
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002293 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002294
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002295 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2296 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002298id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002299 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 no | yes | yes | yes
2302 Arguments : none
2303
2304 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2305 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2306 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002307
2308
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002309ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2310 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2312 no | yes | yes | yes
2313
2314 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2315 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2316 and running).
2317
2318 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2319 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2320 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2321 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2322 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2323
2324 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2325 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2326
2327 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2328 "unless" condition is met.
2329
2330 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2331
2332
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002333log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002334log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002335 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2337 yes | yes | yes | yes
2338 Arguments :
2339 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2340 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2341 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2342 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2343 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2344 parameter.
2345
2346 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2347 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2348
2349 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2350 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2351 standard syslog port).
2352
2353 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2354 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2355 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2356 appropriately writeable).
2357
2358 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2359
2360 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2361 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2362 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2363
2364 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2365 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2366 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002367 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2368 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2369 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2370 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2371 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002372
2373 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2374
2375 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2376 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2377 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2378
2379 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002380 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2381 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2382 "info".
2383
2384 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2385 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2386 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2387 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2388
2389 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2390 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002391
2392 Example :
2393 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002394 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2395 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002396
2397
2398maxconn <conns>
2399 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2401 yes | yes | yes | no
2402 Arguments :
2403 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2404 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2405 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2406 closes.
2407
2408 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2409 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2410 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2411 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2412 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2413 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2414 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2415 properly tuned.
2416
2417 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2418 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2419 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2420
2421 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2422
2423
2424mode { tcp|http|health }
2425 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 yes | yes | yes | yes
2428 Arguments :
2429 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2430 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2431 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2432 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2433
2434 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2435 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2436 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2437 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2438 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2439
2440 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2441 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2442 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2443 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2444 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2445 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2446
2447 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2448 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2449 will be refused.
2450
2451 Example :
2452 defaults http_instances
2453 mode http
2454
2455 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002458monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002459 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2461 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462 Arguments :
2463 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2464 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002465 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2467 backend and its backup.
2468
2469 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2470 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2471 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2472 servers in a list of backends.
2473
2474 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2475 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2476 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2477 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2478 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2479 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2480 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002481 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482
2483 Example:
2484 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002485 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2487 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2488 monitor-uri /site_alive
2489 monitor fail if site_dead
2490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002491 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2492
2493
2494monitor-net <source>
2495 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 yes | yes | yes | no
2498 Arguments :
2499 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2500 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2501 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2502 followed by a mask.
2503
2504 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2505 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002506 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002507 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2508
2509 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2510 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2511 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2512 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2513 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2514
2515 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2516 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2517 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2518 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2519 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2520
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002521 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2522 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2523
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002524 Example :
2525 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2526 frontend www
2527 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2528
2529 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2530
2531
2532monitor-uri <uri>
2533 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2535 yes | yes | yes | no
2536 Arguments :
2537 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2538 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2539
2540 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2541 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2542 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2543 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2544 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2545 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2546 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2547 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2548
2549 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2550 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2551 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2552 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2553 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2554 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2555
2556 Example :
2557 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2558 frontend www
2559 mode http
2560 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2561
2562 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002565option abortonclose
2566no option abortonclose
2567 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2569 yes | no | yes | yes
2570 Arguments : none
2571
2572 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2573 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2574 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2575 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002576 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002577 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2578 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2579 encountered while delivering the response.
2580
2581 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2582 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2583 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2584 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2585 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2586 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002587 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002588 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002589 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002590 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2591 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2592 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2593
2594 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2595 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2596 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2597 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2598 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2599 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2600 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2601 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002602 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002603
2604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2606
2607 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2608
2609
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002610option accept-invalid-http-request
2611no option accept-invalid-http-request
2612 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2614 yes | yes | yes | no
2615 Arguments : none
2616
2617 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2618 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2619 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2620 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2621 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2622 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2623 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2624 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2625 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2626
2627 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2628 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2629 been confirmed.
2630
2631 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2632 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2633 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2634 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2635
2636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2638
2639 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2640 stats socket.
2641
2642
2643option accept-invalid-http-response
2644no option accept-invalid-http-response
2645 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2647 yes | no | yes | yes
2648 Arguments : none
2649
2650 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2651 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2652 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2653 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2654 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2655 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2656 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2657 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2658 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2659
2660 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2661 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2662 been confirmed.
2663
2664 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2665 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2666 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2667 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2668
2669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2671
2672 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2673 stats socket.
2674
2675
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002676option allbackups
2677no option allbackups
2678 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2680 yes | no | yes | yes
2681 Arguments : none
2682
2683 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2684 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2685 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2686 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2687 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2688 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2689 order between the backup servers anymore.
2690
2691 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2692 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2693
2694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2696
2697
2698option checkcache
2699no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002700 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2702 yes | no | yes | yes
2703 Arguments : none
2704
2705 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2706 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002707 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002708 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2709 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2710 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2711
2712 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002713 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002714 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002715 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2716 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002717 to the client are :
2718 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002719 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002720 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002721 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2722 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2723 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2724 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2725 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2726 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2727 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2728 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2729 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2730 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2731 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2732
2733 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002734 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002735 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002736 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002737 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2738
2739 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2740 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002741 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002742 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2743
2744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2746
2747
2748option clitcpka
2749no option clitcpka
2750 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2752 yes | yes | yes | no
2753 Arguments : none
2754
2755 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2756 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2757 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2758 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2759
2760 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2761 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2762 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2763 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2764
2765 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2766 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2767 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2768 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2769 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2770
2771 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2772
2773 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2774 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2775 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2776
2777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2779
2780 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2781
2782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783option contstats
2784 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2786 yes | yes | yes | no
2787 Arguments : none
2788
2789 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2790 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2791 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2792 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2793 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2794 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2795 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2796
2797
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002798option dontlog-normal
2799no option dontlog-normal
2800 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 yes | yes | yes | no
2803 Arguments : none
2804
2805 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2806 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2807 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2808 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2809 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2810 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2811 logged.
2812
2813 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2814 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2815 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002817 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002818 logging.
2819
2820
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002821option dontlognull
2822no option dontlognull
2823 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2825 yes | yes | yes | no
2826 Arguments : none
2827
2828 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2829 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2830 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2831 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2832 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2833 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2834 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2835
2836 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2837 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2838 would not be logged.
2839
2840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002843 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002844
2845
2846option forceclose
2847no option forceclose
2848 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002850 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002851 Arguments : none
2852
2853 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
2854 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
2855 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
2856 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
2857 global session times in the logs.
2858
2859 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01002860 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01002861 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
2862 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
2863 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
2864 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002865
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002866 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
2867 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
2868 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
2869
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2872
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002873 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002874
2875
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002876option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002877 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
2878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2879 yes | yes | yes | yes
2880 Arguments :
2881 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
2882 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002883 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002884 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002885
2886 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
2887 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
2888 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
2889 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
2890 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
2891 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
2892 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002893 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
2894 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
2895 possible that the client has already brought one.
2896
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002897 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002898 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002899 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
2900 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002901 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
2902 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002903
2904 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
2905 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
2906 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
2907 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
2908 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
2909 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
2910 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
2911
2912 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002913 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
2914 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
2915 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002916
2917 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
2918 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
2919 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
2920 when using this option.
2921
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002922 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002923 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
2924 frontend www
2925 mode http
2926 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
2927
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002928 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
2929 backend www
2930 mode http
2931 option forwardfor header X-Client
2932
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002933 See also : "option httpclose"
2934
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002935
2936option http-pretend-keepalive
2937no option http-pretend-keepalive
2938 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 yes | yes | yes | yes
2941 Arguments : none
2942
2943 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
2944 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
2945 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
2946 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
2947 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
2948 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
2949 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
2950 consider the response complete.
2951
2952 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
2953 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
2954 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
2955 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
2956 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
2957 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
2958
2959 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
2960 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
2961 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
2962 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
2963 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
2964 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
2965 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
2966
2967 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
2968 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02002969 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
2970 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
2971 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002972
2973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2975
2976 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
2977
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002978
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002979option http-server-close
2980no option http-server-close
2981 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | yes | yes | yes
2984 Arguments : none
2985
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02002986 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
2987 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
2988 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
2989 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
2990 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
2991 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
2992 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
2993 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
2994 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
2995 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
2996 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
2997 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002998
2999 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3000 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3001 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3002 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003003 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3004 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003005
3006 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3007 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003008 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3009 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3010 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003011
3012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3014
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003015 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3016 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003017
3018
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003019option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003020no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003021 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3023 yes | yes | yes | no
3024 Arguments : none
3025
3026 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3027 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3028 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3029 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3030 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3031 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3032 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3033
3034 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3035 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3036 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3037 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3038 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3039 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3040 request along its whole life.
3041
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003042 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3043 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3044 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3045 front of an existing proxy.
3046
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003047 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3048
3049 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3050 http-server-close".
3051
3052
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003053option httpchk
3054option httpchk <uri>
3055option httpchk <method> <uri>
3056option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3057 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 yes | no | yes | yes
3060 Arguments :
3061 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3062 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3063 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3064 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3065 ones.
3066
3067 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3068 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3069 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3070
3071 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3072 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3073 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3074 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3075 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3076
3077 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3078 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3079 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3080 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3081 the lack of any response.
3082
3083 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3084
3085 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3086 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3087 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3088
3089 Examples :
3090 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3091 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3092 backend https_relay
3093 mode tcp
3094 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3095 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3096
3097 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3098 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3099
3100
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003101option httpclose
3102no option httpclose
3103 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | yes
3106 Arguments : none
3107
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003108 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3109 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3110 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3111 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3112 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3113 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3114 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003115
3116 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003117 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3118 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3119 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3120 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3121 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3122 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003123
3124 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3125 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3126 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003127 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3128 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003129
3130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3132
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003133 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3134 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003135
3136
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003137option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003138 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003141 Arguments :
3142 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3143 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3144 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3145 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3146 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003147
3148 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3149 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3150 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3151 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3152 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3153 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3154 ports.
3155
3156 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3157
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003158 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3159 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3160 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3161 by default.
3162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003164
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003165
3166option http_proxy
3167no option http_proxy
3168 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 yes | yes | yes | yes
3171 Arguments : none
3172
3173 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3174 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3175 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3176 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3177 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3178
3179 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3180 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3181 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3182 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3183 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3184 be analyzed.
3185
3186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3188
3189 Example :
3190 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3191 backend direct_forward
3192 option httpclose
3193 option http_proxy
3194
3195 See also : "option httpclose"
3196
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003197
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003198option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3199 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3200 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3201 no | yes | yes | yes
3202
3203 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3204 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3205 and running).
3206
3207 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3208 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3209 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3210 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3211 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3212
3213 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3214 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3215
3216 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3217 "unless" condition is met.
3218
3219 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3220
3221
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003222option independant-streams
3223no option independant-streams
3224 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3226 yes | yes | yes | yes
3227 Arguments : none
3228
3229 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3230 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3231 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3232 receive data or not.
3233
3234 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3235 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3236 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3237 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3238 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3239 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3240 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3241 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3242 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3243 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3244 socket buffers.
3245
3246 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3247 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3248 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3249 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3250 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3251
3252 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3253
3254
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003255option ldap-check
3256 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3258 yes | no | yes | yes
3259 Arguments : none
3260
3261 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3262 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3263 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3264 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3265
3266 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3267 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3268
3269 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3270 configure it.
3271
3272 Example :
3273 option ldap-check
3274
3275 See also : "option httpchk"
3276
3277
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003278option log-health-checks
3279no option log-health-checks
3280 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3282 yes | no | yes | yes
3283 Arguments : none
3284
3285 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3286 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3287 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3288 of additional information is limited.
3289
3290 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3291 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3292
3293 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3294
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003295
3296option log-separate-errors
3297no option log-separate-errors
3298 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | yes | yes | no
3301 Arguments : none
3302
3303 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3304 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3305 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3306 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3307 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3308 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3309 provides very important information.
3310
3311 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3312 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3313 error logs.
3314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003315 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003316 logging.
3317
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003318
3319option logasap
3320no option logasap
3321 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 yes | yes | yes | no
3324 Arguments : none
3325
3326 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3327 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3328 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3329 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3330 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3331 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3332 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003333 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003334 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3335 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003337 Examples :
3338 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3339 mode http
3340 option httplog
3341 option logasap
3342 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3343
3344 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3345 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3346 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3347 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003349 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003350 logging.
3351
3352
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003353option mysql-check
3354 Use Mysql health checks for server testing
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | no | yes | yes
3357 Arguments : none
3358
3359 The check consists in parsing Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or Error
3360 packet, which is sent by MySQL server on connect. It is a basic but useful
3361 test which does not produce any logging on the server. However, it does not
3362 check database presence nor database consistency, nor user permission to
3363 access. To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
3364
3365 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3366 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3367 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3368 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3369 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3370 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3371
3372 See also: "option httpchk"
3373
3374
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003375option nolinger
3376no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003377 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3379 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003380 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003381
3382 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3383 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3384 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3385 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3386 connections.
3387
3388 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3389 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3390 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3391 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3392 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3393 this too.
3394
3395 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3396 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3397 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3398
3399 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3400 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3401 for servers.
3402
3403 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3404 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3405
3406
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003407option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3408 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3410 yes | yes | yes | yes
3411 Arguments :
3412 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3413 matching <network>
3414 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3415 header name.
3416
3417 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3418 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3419 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3420 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3421 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3422 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3423 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3424 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3425 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3426 possible that the client has already brought one.
3427
3428 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3429 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3430 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3431 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3432 header and requires different one.
3433
3434 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3435 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3436 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3437 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3438 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3439 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3440 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3441
3442 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3443 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3444 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3445 both are defined.
3446
3447 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3448 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3449 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3450 when using this option.
3451
3452 Examples :
3453 # Original Destination address
3454 frontend www
3455 mode http
3456 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3457
3458 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3459 backend www
3460 mode http
3461 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3462
3463 See also : "option httpclose"
3464
3465
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003466option persist
3467no option persist
3468 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003471 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003472
3473 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3474 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3475 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3476 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3477 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3478 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3479 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3480 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3481 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3482 redirected to another valid server.
3483
3484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3486
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003487 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003488
3489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003490option redispatch
3491no option redispatch
3492 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003495 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003496
3497 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3498 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3499 be able to access the service anymore.
3500
3501 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3502 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3503
3504 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3505 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3506 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003508 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3509 "redisp" keywords.
3510
3511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3513
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003514 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003515
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003516
3517option smtpchk
3518option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3519 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003522 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003523 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3524 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3525 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3526
3527 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3528 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3529 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3530
3531 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3532 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3533 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3534 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3535 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3536 dead server.
3537
3538 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3539 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3540 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3541 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3542
3543 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3544 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3545 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3546 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3547 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3548
3549 Example :
3550 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3551
3552 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003555option socket-stats
3556no option socket-stats
3557
3558 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3560 yes | yes | yes | no
3561
3562 Arguments : none
3563
3564
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003565option splice-auto
3566no option splice-auto
3567 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | yes | yes | yes
3570 Arguments : none
3571
3572 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3573 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3574 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3575 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003576 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003577 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3578 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3579 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3580 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3581
3582 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3583 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3584 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3585 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3586 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3587 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3588 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3589 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3590 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3591 keyword.
3592
3593 Example :
3594 option splice-auto
3595
3596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3598
3599 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3600 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3601
3602
3603option splice-request
3604no option splice-request
3605 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 yes | yes | yes | yes
3608 Arguments : none
3609
3610 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3611 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3612 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3613 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3614 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3615 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3616
3617 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3618
3619 Example :
3620 option splice-request
3621
3622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3624
3625 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3626 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3627
3628
3629option splice-response
3630no option splice-response
3631 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3633 yes | yes | yes | yes
3634 Arguments : none
3635
3636 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3637 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3638 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3639 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3640 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3641 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3642
3643 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3644
3645 Example :
3646 option splice-response
3647
3648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3650
3651 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3652 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3653
3654
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003655option srvtcpka
3656no option srvtcpka
3657 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3659 yes | no | yes | yes
3660 Arguments : none
3661
3662 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3663 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3664 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3665 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3666
3667 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3668 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3669 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3670 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3671
3672 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3673 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3674 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3675 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3676 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3677
3678 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3679
3680 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3681 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3682 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3683
3684 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3685 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3686
3687 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3688
3689
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003690option ssl-hello-chk
3691 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3693 yes | no | yes | yes
3694 Arguments : none
3695
3696 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3697 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3698 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3699 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3700 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3701 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3702 hello message.
3703
3704 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3705 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3706 messages, which is appreciable.
3707
3708 See also: "option httpchk"
3709
3710
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003711option tcp-smart-accept
3712no option tcp-smart-accept
3713 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | no
3716 Arguments : none
3717
3718 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3719 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3720 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3721 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3722 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3723 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3724
3725 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3726 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3727 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3728 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3729
3730 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3731 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3732 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3733 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3734
3735 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3736 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3737 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3738
3739 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3740 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3741 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3742
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003743 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3744
3745
3746option tcp-smart-connect
3747no option tcp-smart-connect
3748 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3750 yes | no | yes | yes
3751 Arguments : none
3752
3753 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3754 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3755 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3756 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3757 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3758
3759 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3760 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3761 complex.
3762
3763 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3764 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3765 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3766
3767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3769
3770 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3771
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003772
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003773option tcpka
3774 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments : none
3778
3779 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3780 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3781 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3782 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3783
3784 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3785 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3786 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3787 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3788
3789 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3790 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3791 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3792 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3793 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3794
3795 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3796
3797 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3798 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3799 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3800 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3801 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3802 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3803 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3804 backends.
3805
3806 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3807
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003808
3809option tcplog
3810 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | yes | yes | yes
3813 Arguments : none
3814
3815 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3816 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3817 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3818 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3819 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3820 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3821 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3822 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3823
3824 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003826 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003827
3828
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003829option transparent
3830no option transparent
3831 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003833 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003834 Arguments : none
3835
3836 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3837 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3838 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3839 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3840 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3841 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
3842 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
3843 appropriate server.
3844
3845 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
3846 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
3847
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003848 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
3849 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003850
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003851
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003852persist rdp-cookie
3853persist rdp-cookie(name)
3854 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | no | yes | yes
3857 Arguments :
3858 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003859 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
3860 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003861
3862 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
3863 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
3864 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
3865 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
3866 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
3867 forwarded to this server.
3868
3869 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
3870 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
3871 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003872 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003873 a single "listen" section.
3874
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003875 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
3876 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
3877 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
3878
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003879 Example :
3880 listen tse-farm
3881 bind :3389
3882 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
3883 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
3884 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
3885 # apply RDP cookie persistence
3886 persist rdp-cookie
3887 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
3888 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
3889 balance rdp-cookie
3890 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
3891 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
3892
3893 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
3894
3895
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01003896rate-limit sessions <rate>
3897 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 yes | yes | yes | no
3900 Arguments :
3901 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
3902 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
3903
3904 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
3905 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
3906 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
3907 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
3908 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
3909 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
3910
3911 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
3912 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
3913 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
3914 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
3915
3916 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
3917 listen smtp
3918 mode tcp
3919 bind :25
3920 rate-limit sessions 10
3921 server 127.0.0.1:1025
3922
3923 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
3924 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
3925
3926 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
3927
3928
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003929redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
3930redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003931 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
3932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3933 no | yes | yes | yes
3934
3935 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003936 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003937
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003938 Arguments :
3939 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
3940 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
3941 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
3942 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01003943 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
3944 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
3945 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
3946 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003947
3948 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
3949 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
3950 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
3951 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
3952 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
3953 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
3954 location with a GET method.
3955
3956 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
3957 expected behaviour of a redirection :
3958
3959 - "drop-query"
3960 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
3961 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
3962 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
3963 with a location-type redirect.
3964
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01003965 - "append-slash"
3966 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
3967 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
3968 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
3969 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
3970
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003971 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
3972 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
3973 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
3974 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
3975 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
3976 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
3977 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
3978
3979 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
3980 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
3981 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
3982 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
3983 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
3984 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
3985 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003986
3987 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
3988 acl clear dst_port 80
3989 acl secure dst_port 8080
3990 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003991 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01003992 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003993 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
3994
3995 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01003996 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
3997 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
3998 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003999 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004000
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004001 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4002 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4003 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004005 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004006
4007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004008redisp (deprecated)
4009redispatch (deprecated)
4010 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004013 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004014
4015 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4016 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4017 be able to access the service anymore.
4018
4019 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4020 redistribute them to a working server.
4021
4022 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4023 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4024 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004026 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4027 "option redispatch" instead.
4028
4029 See also : "option redispatch"
4030
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004031
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004032reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004033 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4035 no | yes | yes | yes
4036 Arguments :
4037 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4038 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004039 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004040
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004041 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4042 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4043
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004044 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4045 the last header of an HTTP request.
4046
4047 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4048 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4049 responses.
4050
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004051 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4052 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4053 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4054
4055 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4056 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004057
4058
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004059reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4060reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004061 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 no | yes | yes | yes
4064 Arguments :
4065 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4066 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4067 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4068 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4069 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4070 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4071 ignores case.
4072
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004073 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4074 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4075
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004076 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4077 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4078 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4079 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004080 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004081
4082 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4083 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4084
4085 Example :
4086 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4087 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4088 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4089
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004090 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4091 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004094reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4095reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004096 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 no | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments :
4100 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4101 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4102 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4103 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4104 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4105 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4106
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004107 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4108 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4109
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004110 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4111 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4112 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4113 next servers.
4114
4115 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4116 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4117 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4118
4119 Example :
4120 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4121 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4122 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4123
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004124 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4125 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004126
4127
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004128reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4129reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004130 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 no | yes | yes | yes
4133 Arguments :
4134 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4135 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4136 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4137 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4138 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4139 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4140 case.
4141
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004142 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4143 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4144
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004145 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4146 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4147 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4148 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004149 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004150
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004151 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004152 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004153 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004154
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004155 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4156 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4157
4158 Example :
4159 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4160 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4161 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4162
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004163 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4164 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004165
4166
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004167reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4168reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004169 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4171 no | yes | yes | yes
4172 Arguments :
4173 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4174 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4175 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4176 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4177 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4178 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4179 case.
4180
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004181 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4182 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4183
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004184 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4185 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4186 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4187 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4188
4189 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4190 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4191
4192 Example :
4193 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4194 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4195 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4196 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004198 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4199 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004200
4201
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004202reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4203reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004204 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 no | yes | yes | yes
4207 Arguments :
4208 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4209 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4210 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4211 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4212 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4213 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4214
4215 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4216 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4217 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4218 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004219 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004220
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004221 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4222 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4223
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004224 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4225 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4226 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4227
4228 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4229 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4230 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4231 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4232 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4233
4234 Example :
4235 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4236 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4237 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4238 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4239
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004240 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4241 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004242
4243
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004244reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4245reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004246 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 no | yes | yes | yes
4249 Arguments :
4250 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4251 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4252 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4253 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4254 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4255 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4256 ignores case.
4257
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004258 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4259 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4260
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004261 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4262 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004263 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4264 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4265 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004266 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4267 not set.
4268
4269 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4270 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4271 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4272 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4273 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4274
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004275 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004276 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4277 # block all others.
4278 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4279 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4280
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004281 # block bad guys
4282 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4283 reqitarpit . if badguys
4284
4285 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4286 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004287
4288
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004289retries <value>
4290 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4292 yes | no | yes | yes
4293 Arguments :
4294 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4295 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4296 default value is 3.
4297
4298 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4299 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4300 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4301
4302 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4303 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4304
4305 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4306 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4307
4308 See also : "option redispatch"
4309
4310
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004311rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004312 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 no | yes | yes | yes
4315 Arguments :
4316 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4317 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004318 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004319
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004320 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4321 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4322
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004323 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4324 the last header of an HTTP response.
4325
4326 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4327 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4328 responses.
4329
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004330 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4331 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004332
4333
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004334rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4335rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004336 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4338 no | yes | yes | yes
4339 Arguments :
4340 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4341 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4342 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4343 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4344 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4345 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4346 ignores case.
4347
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004348 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4349 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4350
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004351 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4352 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4353 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4354 client.
4355
4356 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4357 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4358 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4359
4360 Example :
4361 # remove the Server header from responses
4362 reqidel ^Server:.*
4363
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004364 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4365 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004366
4367
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004368rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4369rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 no | yes | yes | yes
4373 Arguments :
4374 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4375 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4376 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4377 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4378 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4379 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4380 ignores case.
4381
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004382 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4383 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4384
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004385 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4386 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4387 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4388 case-sensitive.
4389
4390 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004391 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4392 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4393 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004394
4395 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4396 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4397
4398 Example :
4399 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4400 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4401
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004402 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4403 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004404
4405
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004406rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4407rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004408 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 no | yes | yes | yes
4411 Arguments :
4412 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4413 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4414 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4415 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4416 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4417 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4418 ignores case.
4419
4420 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4421 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4422 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4423 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004424 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004425
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004426 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4427 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4428
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004429 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4430 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4431 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4432
4433 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4434 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4435 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4436 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4437 are not case-sensitive.
4438
4439 Example :
4440 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4441 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4442
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004443 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4444 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004445
4446
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004447server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4448 Declare a server in a backend
4449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4450 no | no | yes | yes
4451 Arguments :
4452 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4453 appear in logs and alerts.
4454
4455 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4456 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004457 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4458 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4459 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4460 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4461 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4462 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4463 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4464 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004465
4466 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4467 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4468 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4469 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4470 adding this value to the client's port.
4471
4472 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4473 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004474 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004475
4476 Examples :
4477 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4478 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004480 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004481
4482
4483source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004484source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004485source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004486 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 yes | no | yes | yes
4489 Arguments :
4490 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4491 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4492 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4493 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4494
4495 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4496 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004497 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4498 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4499 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004500
4501 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4502 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4503 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4504 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4505 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4506 <addr>.
4507
4508 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4509 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4510 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4511 port.
4512
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004513 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4514 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4515 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4516 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4517 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4518 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4519 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4520 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4521 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4522 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4523 HTTP header.
4524
4525 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4526 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4527 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4528 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4529 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4530 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4531 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4532 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4533 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4534 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4535
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004536 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4537 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4538 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4539 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4540 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4541 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4542
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004543 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4544 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4545 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4546 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4547
4548 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4549 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4550 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4551 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4552 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4553 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4554
4555 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4556 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4557 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4558 there are two methods :
4559
4560 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4561 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4562 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4563 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4564 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4565 of the client ranges may be used.
4566
4567 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4568 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4569 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4570 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4571 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4572 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4573 same session.
4574
4575 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4576 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4577 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4578 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4579 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4580 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4581
4582 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4583 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4584 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004585 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004586
4587 Examples :
4588 backend private
4589 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4590 source 192.168.1.200
4591
4592 backend transparent_ssl1
4593 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4594 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4595
4596 backend transparent_ssl2
4597 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4598 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4599 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4600
4601 backend transparent_ssl3
4602 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4603 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4604 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4605
4606 backend transparent_smtp
4607 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4608 # with Tproxy version 4.
4609 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4610
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004611 backend transparent_http
4612 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4613 # proxy.
4614 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004616 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004617 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004619
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004620srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4621 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 yes | no | yes | yes
4624 Arguments :
4625 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4626 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4627 as explained at the top of this document.
4628
4629 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4630 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4631 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4632 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4633 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4634 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4635 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4636
4637 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4638 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4639 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4640 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4641 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004642 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004643 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004644 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004645
4646 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4647 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4648 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4649 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4650 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4651 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4652
4653 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4654 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4655
4656 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4657
4658
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004659stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4660 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4662 no | no | yes | yes
4663
4664 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4665 matched.
4666
4667 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4668 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4669
4670 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4671
4672 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4673 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4674 to alter few servers at a time.
4675
4676 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4677
4678 Example :
4679 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4680 backend stats_localhost
4681 stats enable
4682 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4683
4684 Example :
4685 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4686 backend stats_auth
4687 stats enable
4688 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4689 stats admin if TRUE
4690
4691 Example :
4692 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4693 userlist stats-auth
4694 group admin users admin
4695 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4696 group readonly users haproxy
4697 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4698
4699 backend stats_auth
4700 stats enable
4701 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4702 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4703 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4704 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4705
4706 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
4707 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
4708
4709
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004710stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4711 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4713 yes | no | yes | yes
4714 Arguments :
4715 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4716
4717 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4718
4719 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4720 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4721 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4722 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4723 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4724 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4725
4726 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4727 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4728 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4729 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4730
4731 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4732 report using "stats scope".
4733
4734 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4735 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4736 unobvious parameters.
4737
4738 Example :
4739 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4740 backend public_www
4741 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4742 stats enable
4743 stats hide-version
4744 stats scope .
4745 stats uri /admin?stats
4746 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4747 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4748 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4749
4750 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4751 backend private_monitoring
4752 stats enable
4753 stats uri /admin?stats
4754 stats refresh 5s
4755
4756 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4757
4758
4759stats enable
4760 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 yes | no | yes | yes
4763 Arguments : none
4764
4765 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4766 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4767 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4768 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4769 - stats auth : no authentication
4770 - stats scope : no restriction
4771
4772 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4773 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4774 unobvious parameters.
4775
4776 Example :
4777 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4778 backend public_www
4779 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4780 stats enable
4781 stats hide-version
4782 stats scope .
4783 stats uri /admin?stats
4784 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4785 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4786 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4787
4788 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4789 backend private_monitoring
4790 stats enable
4791 stats uri /admin?stats
4792 stats refresh 5s
4793
4794 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4795
4796
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004797stats hide-version
4798 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004801 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004802
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004803 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4804 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4805 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4806 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4807 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4808 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004810 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4811 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4812 unobvious parameters.
4813
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004814 Example :
4815 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4816 backend public_www
4817 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004818 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004819 stats hide-version
4820 stats scope .
4821 stats uri /admin?stats
4822 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4823 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4824 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004825
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004826 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4827 backend private_monitoring
4828 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004829 stats uri /admin?stats
4830 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004832 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004833
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004834
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004835stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4836 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4837 Access control for statistics
4838
4839 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4840 no | no | yes | yes
4841
4842 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
4843 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
4844 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
4845 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
4846 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
4847 should be asked to enter a username and password.
4848
4849 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
4850 instance.
4851
4852 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4853 about ACL usage.
4854
4855
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004856stats realm <realm>
4857 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | no | yes | yes
4860 Arguments :
4861 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
4862 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
4863 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
4864
4865 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
4866 using a backslash ('\').
4867
4868 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
4869 only related to authentication.
4870
4871 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4872 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4873 unobvious parameters.
4874
4875 Example :
4876 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4877 backend public_www
4878 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4879 stats enable
4880 stats hide-version
4881 stats scope .
4882 stats uri /admin?stats
4883 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4884 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4885 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4886
4887 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4888 backend private_monitoring
4889 stats enable
4890 stats uri /admin?stats
4891 stats refresh 5s
4892
4893 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
4894
4895
4896stats refresh <delay>
4897 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | no | yes | yes
4900 Arguments :
4901 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
4902 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
4903 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
4904 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
4905 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
4906 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
4907
4908 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
4909 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
4910 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
4911 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
4912
4913 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4914 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4915 unobvious parameters.
4916
4917 Example :
4918 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4919 backend public_www
4920 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4921 stats enable
4922 stats hide-version
4923 stats scope .
4924 stats uri /admin?stats
4925 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4926 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4927 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4928
4929 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4930 backend private_monitoring
4931 stats enable
4932 stats uri /admin?stats
4933 stats refresh 5s
4934
4935 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4936
4937
4938stats scope { <name> | "." }
4939 Enable statistics and limit access scope
4940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4941 yes | no | yes | yes
4942 Arguments :
4943 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
4944 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
4945 section in which the statement appears.
4946
4947 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
4948 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
4949 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
4950 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
4951 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
4952 exists.
4953
4954 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4955 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4956 unobvious parameters.
4957
4958 Example :
4959 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4960 backend public_www
4961 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4962 stats enable
4963 stats hide-version
4964 stats scope .
4965 stats uri /admin?stats
4966 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4967 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4968 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4969
4970 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4971 backend private_monitoring
4972 stats enable
4973 stats uri /admin?stats
4974 stats refresh 5s
4975
4976 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4977
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004978
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02004979stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004980 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
4981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 yes | no | yes | yes
4983
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02004984 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004985 description from global section is automatically used instead.
4986
4987 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
4988 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
4989
4990 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4991 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4992 unobvious parameters.
4993
4994 Example :
4995 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4996 backend private_monitoring
4997 stats enable
4998 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
4999 stats uri /admin?stats
5000 stats refresh 5s
5001
5002 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5003 global section.
5004
5005
5006stats show-legends
5007 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5008 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5009 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5010 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5011 - IP (socket, server)
5012 - cookie (backend, server)
5013
5014 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5015 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5016 unobvious parameters.
5017
5018 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5019
5020
5021stats show-node [ <name> ]
5022 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | no | yes | yes
5025 Arguments:
5026 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5027 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5028
5029 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5030 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5031 provided for each customer.
5032
5033 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5034 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5035 unobvious parameters.
5036
5037 Example:
5038 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5039 backend private_monitoring
5040 stats enable
5041 stats show-node Europe-1
5042 stats uri /admin?stats
5043 stats refresh 5s
5044
5045 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5046 section.
5047
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005048
5049stats uri <prefix>
5050 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5052 yes | no | yes | yes
5053 Arguments :
5054 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5055 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5056 query string.
5057
5058 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5059 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5060 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5061 possible to reach it in the application.
5062
5063 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005064 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005065 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5066 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5067 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5068 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5069
5070 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5071 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5072 an address or a port to statistics only.
5073
5074 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5075 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5076 unobvious parameters.
5077
5078 Example :
5079 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5080 backend public_www
5081 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5082 stats enable
5083 stats hide-version
5084 stats scope .
5085 stats uri /admin?stats
5086 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5087 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5088 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5089
5090 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5091 backend private_monitoring
5092 stats enable
5093 stats uri /admin?stats
5094 stats refresh 5s
5095
5096 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5097
5098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005099stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5100 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005102 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005103
5104 Arguments :
5105 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5106 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5107 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5108 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5109
5110 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5111 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5112 the "stick-table" statement.
5113
5114 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5115 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5116 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5117 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5118 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5119
5120 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5121 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5122 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5123 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5124 transformation rules.
5125
5126 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5127 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5128 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5129 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5130 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5131 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5132 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5133
5134 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5135 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5136 ACL based conditions.
5137
5138 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5139 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5140 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5141 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5142
5143 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5144 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5145 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5146 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5147
5148 Example :
5149 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5150 # last 30 minutes
5151 backend pop
5152 mode tcp
5153 balance roundrobin
5154 stick store-request src
5155 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5156 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5157 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5158
5159 backend smtp
5160 mode tcp
5161 balance roundrobin
5162 stick match src table pop
5163 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5164 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5165
5166 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5167 extraction.
5168
5169
5170stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5171 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5173 no | no | yes | yes
5174
5175 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5176 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5177 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5178 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5179
5180 Examples :
5181 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005182 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005183
5184 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5185 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5186 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5187
5188
5189 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5190 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5191 backend http
5192 mode http
5193 balance roundrobin
5194 stick on src table https
5195 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5196 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5197 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5198
5199 backend https
5200 mode tcp
5201 balance roundrobin
5202 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5203 stick on src
5204 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5205 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5206
5207 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5208
5209
5210stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5211 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5213 no | no | yes | yes
5214
5215 Arguments :
5216 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5217 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5218 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5219 server is selected.
5220
5221 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5222 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5223 the "stick-table" statement.
5224
5225 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5226 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5227 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5228 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5229 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5230 address.
5231
5232 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5233 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5234 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5235 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5236 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5237 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5238 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5239 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5240 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5241 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5242
5243 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5244 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5245 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5246 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5247 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5248 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5249 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5250
5251 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5252 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5253 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5254 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5255
5256 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5257 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5258 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5259 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5260 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5261 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5262 another protocol or access method.
5263
5264 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5265 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5266 the request.
5267
5268 Example :
5269 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5270 # last 30 minutes
5271 backend pop
5272 mode tcp
5273 balance roundrobin
5274 stick store-request src
5275 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5276 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5277 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5278
5279 backend smtp
5280 mode tcp
5281 balance roundrobin
5282 stick match src table pop
5283 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5284 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5285
5286 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5287 extraction.
5288
5289
5290stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] } size <size>
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005291 [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005292 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005294 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005295
5296 Arguments :
5297 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5298 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5299 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5300 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5301
5302 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5303 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5304 instance.
5305
5306 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5307 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5308 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5309 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5310 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5311 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
5312 to 31 characters.
5313
5314 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
5315 "string" type table. See type "string" above. Be careful when
5316 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5317 increase.
5318
5319 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005320 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5321 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5322 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005323
5324 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5325 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5326 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5327 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5328 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5329 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5330 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5331 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5332 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5333 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5334 parameter (see below).
5335
5336 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5337 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5338 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5339 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5340 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5341 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5342 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5343 if not expiration delay is specified.
5344
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005345 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5346 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5347 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5348 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005349 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5350 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5351 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5352 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5353 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5354 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5355 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5356 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5357 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5358 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5359 types and their arguments.
5360
5361 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5362 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5363 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5364 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5365
5366 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5367 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5368 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5369 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5370
5371 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5372 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5373 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5374 they were received.
5375
5376 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5377 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5378 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5379 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5380 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5381
5382 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5383 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5384 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5385 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5386 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5387
5388 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5389 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5390 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5391
5392 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5393 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5394 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5395 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5396 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5397
5398 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5399 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5400 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5401 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5402 the client side.
5403
5404 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5405 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5406 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5407 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5408 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5409 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5410 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5411
5412 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5413 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5414 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5415 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5416 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5417 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5418 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5419
5420 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5421 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5422 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5423 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5424 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5425 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5426
5427 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5428 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5429 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5430 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5431
5432 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5433 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5434 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5435 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5436 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5437 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5438 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5439 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5440 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5441 recommended for better fairness.
5442
5443 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5444 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5445 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5446 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5447
5448 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5449 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5450 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5451 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5452 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5453 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5454 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5455 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5456 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5457 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005458
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005459 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5460 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005461 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5462 reference it.
5463
5464 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5465 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5466 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5467 as an exclusive stickiness.
5468
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005469 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5470 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5471 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5472 something that can be ignored.
5473
5474 Example:
5475 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5476 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5477 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5478 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5479
5480 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5481 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005482
5483
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005484tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5485 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005488 Arguments :
5489 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5490 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5491 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005493 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005494
5495 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5496 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005497 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5498 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5499 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5500 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5501 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5502 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005503
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005504 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5505 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5506 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5507 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005509 Three types of actions are supported :
5510 - accept :
5511 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5512 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5513 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005514
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005515 - reject :
5516 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5517 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5518 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5519 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5520 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5521 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5522 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5523 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5524 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5525 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5526 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5527 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005529 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5530 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5531 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5532 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5533 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5534 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5535 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5536 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5537 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005538
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005539 These actions take one or two arguments :
5540 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5541 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5542 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005544 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5545 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5546 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5547 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005549 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5550 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5551 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5552 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5553 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5554 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5555 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5556 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5557 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5558 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005560 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5561 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5562 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005564 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5565 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5566 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005567
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005568 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005569 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005570 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005572 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5573 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5574 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005575
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005576 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5577 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5578 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005579
5580 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5581
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005582 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005583
5584
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005585tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5586 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005588 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005589 Arguments :
5590 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5591 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5592 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005594 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005595
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005596 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5597 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5598 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5599 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5600 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005602 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5603 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5604 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5605 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5606 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5607 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5608 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5609 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5610 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005611
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005612 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5613 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5614 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5615 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005617 Three types of actions are supported :
5618 - accept :
5619 - reject :
5620 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005622 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5623 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005625 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5626 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5627 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5628 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5629 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5630 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005632 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005633 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5634 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005636 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5637 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5638 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5639 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5640 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005641
5642 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005643 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5644 # and reject everything else.
5645 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5646 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5647 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5648 tcp-request content reject
5649
5650 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005651 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5652 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5653 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005654 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005655
5656 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5657 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5658 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005659 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005660 tcp-request content reject
5661
5662 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5663 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5664
5665 frontend http
5666 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5667 # protecting all our sites
5668 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5669 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5670 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5671 ...
5672 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5673
5674 backend http_dynamic
5675 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5676 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5677 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5678 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5679 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5680 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5681 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005683 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005685 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005686
5687
5688tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5689 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005691 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005692 Arguments :
5693 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5694 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5695 as explained at the top of this document.
5696
5697 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5698 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5699 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5700 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5701 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5702
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005703 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5704 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5705 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5706 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5707
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005708 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5709 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005710 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005711 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005712 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5713 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5714 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5715 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005716
5717 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5718 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5719 it pass through unaffected.
5720
5721 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5722 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5723 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005724 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005725 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5726 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005727 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
5728 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
5729 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005730
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005731 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005732 "timeout client".
5733
5734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005735timeout check <timeout>
5736 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
5737 established.
5738
5739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5740 yes | no | yes | yes
5741 Arguments:
5742 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5743 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5744 as explained at the top of this document.
5745
5746 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
5747 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
5748 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
5749 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01005750 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
5751 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
5752 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005753
5754 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
5755 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
5756
5757 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
5758 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005759 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005760
5761 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5762 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5763 forget about it.
5764
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005765 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
5766 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005767
5768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005769timeout client <timeout>
5770timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5771 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
5772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5773 yes | yes | yes | no
5774 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5777 as explained at the top of this document.
5778
5779 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
5780 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5781 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
5782 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
5783 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
5784 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
5785 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
5786 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005787 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005788 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
5789 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
5790
5791 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
5792 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5793 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5794 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5795 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5796 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5797
5798 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
5799 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
5800 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5801
5802 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
5803
5804
5805timeout connect <timeout>
5806timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5807 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
5808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5809 yes | no | yes | yes
5810 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005811 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5813 as explained at the top of this document.
5814
5815 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005816 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005817 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005818 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005819 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
5820 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005821
5822 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5823 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5824 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5825 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5826 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
5827 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5828
5829 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
5830 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
5831 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5832
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005833 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
5834 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005835
5836
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005837timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
5838 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 yes | yes | yes | yes
5841 Arguments :
5842 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5844 as explained at the top of this document.
5845
5846 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
5847 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
5848 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
5849 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
5850 once the request has started to present itself.
5851
5852 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
5853 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
5854 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
5855 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
5856 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
5857
5858 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
5859 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
5860 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
5861 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
5862
5863 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
5864 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
5865 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
5866 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
5867 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02005868 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005869
5870 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
5871 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
5872 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
5873 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
5874
5875 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
5876
5877
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005878timeout http-request <timeout>
5879 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
5880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005881 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005882 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5885 as explained at the top of this document.
5886
5887 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
5888 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
5889 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
5890 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
5891 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
5892 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
5893 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
5894 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
5895
5896 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
5897 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005898 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
5899 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005900
5901 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
5902 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
5903 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
5904 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
5905 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
5906
5907 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005908 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
5909 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
5910 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005911
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005912 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005913
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005914
5915timeout queue <timeout>
5916 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | no | yes | yes
5919 Arguments :
5920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5922 as explained at the top of this document.
5923
5924 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
5925 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
5926 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
5927 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
5928 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
5929
5930 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
5931 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
5932 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
5933 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
5934
5935 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5936
5937
5938timeout server <timeout>
5939timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5940 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5942 yes | no | yes | yes
5943 Arguments :
5944 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5945 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5946 as explained at the top of this document.
5947
5948 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5949 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5950 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5951 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5952 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5953 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5954 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5955
5956 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5957 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5958 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5959 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5960 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005961 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005962 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005963 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005964
5965 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5966 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5967 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5968 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5969 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5970 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5971
5972 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
5973 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
5974 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5975
5976 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
5977
5978
5979timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005980 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 yes | yes | yes | yes
5983 Arguments :
5984 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
5985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5986 as explained at the top of this document.
5987
5988 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
5989 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
5990 defines how long it will be maintained open.
5991
5992 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5993 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5994 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
5995 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005996 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005997
5998 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5999
6000
6001transparent (deprecated)
6002 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006004 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006005 Arguments : none
6006
6007 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6008 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6009 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6010 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6011 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6012 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6013 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6014 appropriate server.
6015
6016 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6017
6018 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6019 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6020
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006021 See also: "option transparent"
6022
6023
6024use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6025use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006026 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 no | yes | yes | no
6029 Arguments :
6030 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006032 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006033
6034 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6035 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6036 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006037 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6038 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6039 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6040 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006041
6042 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6043 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6044 assign the backend.
6045
6046 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6047 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6048 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6049 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6050 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6051 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6052
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006053 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006054 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006055 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6056 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6057 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6058
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006059 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006060
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010060625. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006063------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006065The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6066which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6067arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6068settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6069after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6070Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6071address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006073 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006074 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006076The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006078addr <ipv4>
6079 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6080 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6081 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6082 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6083 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006085 Supported in default-server: No
6086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006087backup
6088 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6089 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6090 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6091 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6092 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6093 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006095 Supported in default-server: No
6096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006097check
6098 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6099 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6100 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6101 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6102 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6103 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6104 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6105 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6106 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006107 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6108 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006110 Supported in default-server: No
6111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006112cookie <value>
6113 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6114 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6115 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6116 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6117 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6118 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6119 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006121 Supported in default-server: No
6122
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006123disabled
6124 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6125 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6126 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6127 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6128 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6129
6130 Supported in default-server: No
6131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006132error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006133 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6134 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6135 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006137 Supported in default-server: Yes
6138
6139 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006141fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006142 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6143 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6144 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006146 Supported in default-server: Yes
6147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006148id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006149 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6150 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6151 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006153 Supported in default-server: No
6154
6155inter <delay>
6156fastinter <delay>
6157downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006158 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6159 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6160 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6161 between checks depending on the server state :
6162
6163 Server state | Interval used
6164 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6165 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6166 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6167 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6168 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6169 or yet unchecked. |
6170 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6171 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6172 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006174 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6175 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6176 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6177 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6178 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6179 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6180 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6181 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6182 servers.
6183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006184 Supported in default-server: Yes
6185
6186maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006187 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6188 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6189 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6190 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6191 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6192 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6193 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6194 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006196 Supported in default-server: Yes
6197
6198maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006199 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6200 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6201 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6202 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6203 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6204 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6205 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006207 Supported in default-server: Yes
6208
6209minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006210 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6211 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6212 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6213 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6214 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6215 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006216 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006217 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006219 Supported in default-server: Yes
6220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006221observe <mode>
6222 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6223 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6224 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6225 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6226 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6227 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6228 headers, a timeout, etc.
6229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006230 Supported in default-server: No
6231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006232 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6233
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006234on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006235 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6236 Currently, four modes are available:
6237 - fastinter: force fastinter
6238 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6239 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6240 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6241 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006243 Supported in default-server: Yes
6244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006245 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006247port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006248 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6249 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6250 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6251 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6252 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6253 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006255 Supported in default-server: Yes
6256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006257redir <prefix>
6258 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6259 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6260 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6261 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6262 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6263 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6264 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6265 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006266 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006267 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6268 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6269 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6270 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6271 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6272
6273 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006275 Supported in default-server: No
6276
6277rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006278 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6279 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6280 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006282 Supported in default-server: Yes
6283
6284slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006285 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6286 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6287 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6288 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6289 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6290 parameters :
6291
6292 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6293 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6294
6295 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6296 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6297 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6298 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6299
6300 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6301 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6302 seen as failed.
6303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006304 Supported in default-server: Yes
6305
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006306source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006307source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006308source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006309 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6310 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6311 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6312 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6313
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006314 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6315 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6316 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6317 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6318 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6319 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6320 server.
6321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006322 Supported in default-server: No
6323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006324track [<proxy>/]<server>
6325 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6326 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6327 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6328 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6329 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006331 Supported in default-server: No
6332
6333weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006334 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6335 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6336 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006337 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6338 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6339 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6340 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6341 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6342 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006344 Supported in default-server: Yes
6345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006346
63476. HTTP header manipulation
6348---------------------------
6349
6350In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6351response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6352request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6353which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6354against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6355to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6356passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6357headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6358never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6359
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006360There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6361(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6362rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6363messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6364in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006365happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006366add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6367normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006369This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6370in section 4.2 :
6371
6372 - reqadd <string>
6373 - reqallow <search>
6374 - reqiallow <search>
6375 - reqdel <search>
6376 - reqidel <search>
6377 - reqdeny <search>
6378 - reqideny <search>
6379 - reqpass <search>
6380 - reqipass <search>
6381 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6382 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6383 - reqtarpit <search>
6384 - reqitarpit <search>
6385 - rspadd <string>
6386 - rspdel <search>
6387 - rspidel <search>
6388 - rspdeny <search>
6389 - rspideny <search>
6390 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6391 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6392
6393With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6394is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6395parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6396prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6397Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6398
6399 \t for a tab
6400 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6401 \n for a new line (LF)
6402 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6403 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6404 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6405 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6406 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6407
6408The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6409portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6410above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6411regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
64129 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6413is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6414
6415The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6416after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6417
6418Notes related to these keywords :
6419---------------------------------
6420 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6421 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6422 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6423
6424 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6425 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6426 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6427
6428 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6429 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6430 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6431 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6432 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6433
6434 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6435 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6436 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6437 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6438 useless headers before adding new ones.
6439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006440 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006441 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6442
6443 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6444 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6445 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6446
6447 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6448 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006449 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006450
6451
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010064527. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6453------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006454
6455The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6456content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6457from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6458simple :
6459
6460 - define test criteria with sets of values
6461 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6462
6463The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6464
6465In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6466
6467 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6468
6469This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6470Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6471and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6472an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6473of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6474
6475ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6476'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6477which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6478
6479There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6480performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6481
6482The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6483
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006484 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6485 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006486 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6487
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006488The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6489specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6490possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006491multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6492be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6493needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6494space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6495match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6496lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6497duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6498to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6499instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006500
6501 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6502
6503In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6504the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6505case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6506too.
6507
6508Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6509a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6510ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6511
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006512Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006513
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006514 - integers or integer ranges
6515 - strings
6516 - regular expressions
6517 - IP addresses and networks
6518
6519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065207.1. Matching integers
6521----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006522
6523Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6524that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6525expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6526may be omitted.
6527
6528For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6529unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6530representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6531
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006532As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6533two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6534instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6535ranges and operators.
6536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006537For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006538operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6539Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6540of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006542Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006543
6544 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6545 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6546 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6547 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6548 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6549
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006550For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006551
6552 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6553
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006554This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6555
6556 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065597.2. Matching strings
6560---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006561
6562String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6563exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6564characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6565string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6566to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006567before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006568
6569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065707.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6571-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006572
6573Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6574they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6575possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6576passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6577the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006578the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6579match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006580
6581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065827.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6583----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006584
6585IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6586netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6587within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006588host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006589difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6590at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6591does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6592parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006593
6594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065957.5. Available matching criteria
6596--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065987.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6599------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006600
6601A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6602analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6603addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006605always_false
6606 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6607 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6608
6609always_true
6610 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6611 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6612
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006613avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006614avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006615 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6616 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6617 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6618 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6619 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6620 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6621 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6622 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6623 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6624 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6625 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006626
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006627be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006628be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006629 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6630 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6631 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6632 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6633 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006634
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006635be_sess_rate <integer>
6636be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6637 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6638 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6639 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6640 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6641 sucking of an online dictionary).
6642
6643 Example :
6644 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6645 backend dynamic
6646 mode http
6647 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6648 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006649
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006650connslots <integer>
6651connslots(backend) <integer>
6652 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006653 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006654 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6655
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006656 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6657 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006658
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006659 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006660 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6661 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6662 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6663 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6664 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006665 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006666
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006667 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
6668 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
6669 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
6670 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006671
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006672dst <ip_address>
6673 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
6674 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006675
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006676dst_conn <integer>
6677 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
6678 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
6679 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
6680 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
6681 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
6682 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
6683
6684dst_port <integer>
6685 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
6686 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
6687
6688fe_conn <integer>
6689fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
6690 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
6691 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
6692 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6693 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
6694 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
6695 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
6696 criteria.
6697
6698fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006699 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006700 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006701
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006702fe_sess_rate <integer>
6703fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
6704 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
6705 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
6706 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
6707 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
6708 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
6709 the rate to go down below the limit.
6710
6711 Example :
6712 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
6713 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
6714 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
6715 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
6716 frontend mail
6717 bind :25
6718 mode tcp
6719 maxconn 100
6720 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
6721 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
6722 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
6723 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006724
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006725nbsrv <integer>
6726nbsrv(backend) <integer>
6727 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
6728 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
6729 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
6730 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
6731 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006732
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006733queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02006734queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006735 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
6736 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
6737 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
6738 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
6739 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
6740 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
6741 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
6742
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006743sc1_bytes_in_rate
6744sc2_bytes_in_rate
6745 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
6746 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6747 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
6748
6749sc1_bytes_out_rate
6750sc2_bytes_out_rate
6751 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
6752 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6753 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
6754
6755sc1_conn_cnt
6756sc2_conn_cnt
6757 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
6758 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
6759
6760sc1_conn_cur
6761sc2_conn_cur
6762 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
6763 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
6764 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
6765
6766sc1_conn_rate
6767sc2_conn_rate
6768 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
6769 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
6770 See also src_conn_rate.
6771
6772sc1_get_gpc0
6773sc2_get_gpc0
6774 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6775 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
6776
6777sc1_http_err_cnt
6778sc2_http_err_cnt
6779 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
6780 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
6781 See also src_http_err_cnt.
6782
6783sc1_http_err_rate
6784sc2_http_err_rate
6785 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
6786 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
6787 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
6788 src_http_err_rate.
6789
6790sc1_http_req_cnt
6791sc2_http_req_cnt
6792 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6793 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6794 src_http_req_cnt.
6795
6796sc1_http_req_rate
6797sc2_http_req_rate
6798 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6799 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
6800 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6801 src_http_req_rate.
6802
6803sc1_inc_gpc0
6804sc2_inc_gpc0
6805 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
6806 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
6807 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
6808 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
6809 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
6810 when a first ACL was verified :
6811
6812 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6813 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
6814 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
6815
6816sc1_kbytes_in
6817sc2_kbytes_in
6818 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
6819 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6820 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6821 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
6822
6823sc1_kbytes_out
6824sc2_kbytes_out
6825 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
6826 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6827 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6828 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
6829
6830sc1_sess_cnt
6831sc2_sess_cnt
6832 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
6833 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
6834 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
6835 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
6836 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
6837 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
6838
6839sc1_sess_rate
6840sc2_sess_rate
6841 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
6842 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
6843 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
6844 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
6845 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
6846 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
6847
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006848so_id <integer>
6849 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
6850
6851src <ip_address>
6852 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
6853 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
6854 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
6855
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006856src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
6857src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
6858 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6859 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6860 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006861 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006862
6863src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
6864src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
6865 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
6866 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6867 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006868 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006869
6870src_conn_cnt <integer>
6871src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
6872 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6873 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6874 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006875 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006876
6877src_conn_cur <integer>
6878src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
6879 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
6880 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
6881 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006882 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006883
6884src_conn_rate <integer>
6885src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
6886 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
6887 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6888 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006889 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006890
6891src_get_gpc0 <integer>
6892src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
6893 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6894 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6895 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006896 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006897
6898src_http_err_cnt <integer>
6899src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
6900 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
6901 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6902 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006903 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006904
6905src_http_err_rate <integer>
6906src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
6907 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
6908 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
6909 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
6910 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006911 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006912
6913src_http_req_cnt <integer>
6914src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
6915 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6916 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6917 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006918 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006919
6920src_http_req_rate <integer>
6921src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
6922 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6923 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6924 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
6925 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006926 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006927
6928src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
6929src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
6930 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
6931 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6932 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
6933 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
6934 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
6935 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
6936
6937 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
6938 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006939 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006940
6941src_kbytes_in <integer>
6942src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
6943 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
6944 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6945 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6946 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006947 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006948
6949src_kbytes_out <integer>
6950src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
6951 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
6952 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6953 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6954 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006955 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006957src_port <integer>
6958 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006959
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006960src_sess_cnt <integer>
6961src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
6962 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6963 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
6964 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
6965 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006966 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006967
6968src_sess_rate <integer>
6969src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
6970 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6971 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6972 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
6973 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006974 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006975
6976src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
6977src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006978 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006979 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
6980 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006981 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
6982 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
6983 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006984 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006985
6986 Example :
6987 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
6988 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
6989 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
6990 listen ssh
6991 bind :22
6992 mode tcp
6993 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006994 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006995 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
6996 server local 127.0.0.1:22
6997
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02006998srv_is_up(<server>)
6999srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7000 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7001 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7002 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7003 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7004 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7005 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7006 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7007 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020070107.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7011---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007012
7013A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7014during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007015through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7016keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007017
7018req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007019 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007020 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7021 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7022 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7023 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7024 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7025 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7026
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007027req_proto_http
7028 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7029 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007030 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007031 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7032 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7033
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007034req_rdp_cookie <string>
7035req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7036 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7037 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7038 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7039 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7040 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7041 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7042 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7043 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7044
7045req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7046req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7047 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7048 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7049 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7050 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7051 cookies.
7052
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007053req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7054 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7055 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7056 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7057 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7058 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7059 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7060 with TCP request content inspection.
7061
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007062wait_end
7063 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7064 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7065 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7066 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7067 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7068 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7069 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7070 inspection.
7071
7072 Examples :
7073 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7074 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7075 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7076
7077 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7078 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7079 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7080 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7081 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7082 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7083 tcp-request content reject
7084
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070867.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7087--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007088
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007089A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007090application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7091read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7092than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7093
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007094hdr <string>
7095hdr(header) <string>
7096 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7097 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7098 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7099 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7100 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7101
7102 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7103 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7104 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7105
7106 hdr(Connection) -i close
7107
7108hdr_beg <string>
7109hdr_beg(header) <string>
7110 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7111 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7112 response headers sent by the server.
7113
7114hdr_cnt <integer>
7115hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7116 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7117 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7118 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7119 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7120 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7121 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7122 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7123
7124hdr_dir <string>
7125hdr_dir(header) <string>
7126 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7127 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7128 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7129 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7130 headers sent by the server.
7131
7132hdr_dom <string>
7133hdr_dom(header) <string>
7134 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7135 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7136 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7137 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7138 server.
7139
7140hdr_end <string>
7141hdr_end(header) <string>
7142 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7143 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7144 response headers sent by the server.
7145
7146hdr_ip <ip_address>
7147hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7148 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7149 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7150 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7151 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7152
7153hdr_reg <regex>
7154hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7155 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7156 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7157 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7158 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7159 response headers sent by the server.
7160
7161hdr_sub <string>
7162hdr_sub(header) <string>
7163 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7164 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7165 response headers sent by the server.
7166
7167hdr_val <integer>
7168hdr_val(header) <integer>
7169 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7170 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7171 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7172 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7173
7174http_auth(userlist)
7175http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7176 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7177 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7178 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7179 of specified groups.
7180
7181 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7182
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007183method <string>
7184 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7185 already check for most common methods.
7186
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007187path <string>
7188 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7189 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7190 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7191
7192path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007193 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7194 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007195
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007196path_dir <string>
7197 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7198 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7199 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7200 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7201
7202path_dom <string>
7203 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7204 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7205 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007207path_end <string>
7208 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7209 control file name extension.
7210
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007211path_reg <regex>
7212 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7213 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7214 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007216path_sub <string>
7217 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7218 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7219 "path_dir".
7220
7221req_ver <string>
7222 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7223 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7224
7225status <integer>
7226 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7227 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7228 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7229
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007230url <string>
7231 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7232 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7233
7234url_beg <string>
7235 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7236 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7237
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007238url_dir <string>
7239 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7240 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7241 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7242 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7243
7244url_dom <string>
7245 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7246 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7247 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7248
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007249url_end <string>
7250 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7251 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007252
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007253url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007254 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7255 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007256 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007257
7258url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007259 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7260 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007261 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007262 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007263
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007264url_reg <regex>
7265 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7266 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7267 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007268
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007269url_sub <string>
7270 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7271 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007272
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072747.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7275---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007277Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7278every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007279order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007281ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7282---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007283FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007284HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007285HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7286HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007287HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7288HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7289HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7290HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7291LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007292METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7293METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7294METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7295METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7296METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7297METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007298RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007299REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007300TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007301WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7302---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007303
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073057.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7306----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007308Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7309combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007311 - AND (implicit)
7312 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7313 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007315A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007317 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007319Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7320indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007322For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7323"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7324requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7325is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007327 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7328 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7329 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7330 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007332To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7333and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007335 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7336 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7337 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7338 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007340 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7341 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7342 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7343 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007344
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007345It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7346expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7347be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7348the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7349
7350 The following rule :
7351
7352 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7353 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7354
7355 Can also be written that way :
7356
7357 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7358
7359It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7360to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7361simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7362sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7363good use is the following :
7364
7365 With named ACLs :
7366
7367 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7368 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7369 monitor fail if site_dead
7370
7371 With anonymous ACLs :
7372
7373 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007375See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007376
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007377
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010073787.8. Pattern extraction
7379-----------------------
7380
7381The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7382response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7383for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7384
7385All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7386"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7387begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7388arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7389much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7390equivalent used in ACLs.
7391
7392The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7393
7394 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7395 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7396
7397 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7398 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7399 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7400 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7401
7402 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7403 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7404 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7405 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7406 type integer and only works with such tables.
7407
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007408 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7409 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7410 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7411 x-forwarded-for header.
7412
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007413
7414The currently available list of transformations include :
7415
7416 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7417 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7418 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7419
7420 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7421 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7422 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7423
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007424 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7425 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7426 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7427 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7428 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7429
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074318. Logging
7432----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007434One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7435provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7436very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7437provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7438state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007439to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007440headers.
7441
7442In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7443about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7444send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7445
7446 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7447 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7448 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7449 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7450 at the termination.
7451
7452The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7453allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7454as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7455while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7456real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7457delay.
7458
7459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074608.1. Log levels
7461---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007462
7463TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7464source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7465HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7466in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7467particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007468syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007469facilities.
7470
7471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074728.2. Log formats
7473----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007474
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007475HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007476and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7477the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7478formats are the following ones :
7479
7480 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7481 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7482 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7483 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7484 extents.
7485
7486 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7487 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7488 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7489 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7490 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7491
7492 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7493 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7494 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7495 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7496 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7497
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007498 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7499 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7500 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7501 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7502
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007503Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7504specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7505field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7506servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7507always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7508identifier.
7509
7510Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7511 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7512 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7513 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7514 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7515
7516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075178.2.1. Default log format
7518-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007519
7520This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7521as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7522format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7523
7524 Example :
7525 listen www
7526 mode http
7527 log global
7528 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7529
7530 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7531 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7532 (www/HTTP)
7533
7534 Field Format Extract from the example above
7535 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7536 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7537 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7538 4 'to' to
7539 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7540 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7541
7542Detailed fields description :
7543 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7544 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7545 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7546 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7547 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7548 and processed the connection.
7549 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7550
7551It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7552will eventually disappear.
7553
7554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075558.2.2. TCP log format
7556---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007557
7558The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7559is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7560information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7561counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7562emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7563environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7564the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7565sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007566specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7567not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7568fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7569marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007570
7571 Example :
7572 frontend fnt
7573 mode tcp
7574 option tcplog
7575 log global
7576 default_backend bck
7577
7578 backend bck
7579 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7580
7581 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7582 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7583 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7584
7585 Field Format Extract from the example above
7586 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7587 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7588 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7589 4 frontend_name fnt
7590 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7591 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7592 7 bytes_read* 212
7593 8 termination_state --
7594 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7595 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7596
7597Detailed fields description :
7598 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7599 connection to haproxy.
7600
7601 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7602
7603 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7604 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7605 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7606 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7607
7608 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7609 and processed the connection.
7610
7611 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7612 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7613 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7614 applications.
7615
7616 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7617 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7618 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7619 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7620 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
7621
7622 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7623 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7624 See "Timers" below for more details.
7625
7626 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7627 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7628 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
7629 "Timers" below for more details.
7630
7631 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7632 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7633 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7634 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7635 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7636 details.
7637
7638 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
7639 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
7640 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
7641 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
7642 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
7643
7644 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7645 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7646 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
7647 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
7648 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
7649 for more details.
7650
7651 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7652 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7653 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
7654 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
7655 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007656 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007657
7658 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7659 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7660 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7661 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7662 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7663 caused by a denial of service attack.
7664
7665 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7666 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7667 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7668 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7669 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7670 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7671 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7672 denial of service attack.
7673
7674 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7675 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7676 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7677 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7678 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7679 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7680 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7681 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
7682 be processed than on other servers.
7683
7684 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7685 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7686 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7687 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7688 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7689 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7690 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7691 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7692 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7693 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7694 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7695 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7696 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7697
7698 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7699 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7700 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7701 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7702 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7703 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7704 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7705 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7706
7707 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7708 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7709 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7710 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7711 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7712 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7713 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7714 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7715 occurs.
7716
7717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077188.2.3. HTTP log format
7719----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007720
7721The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
7722is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
7723the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
7724are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
7725emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
7726generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
7727"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
7728which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007729frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
7730is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007731
7732Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
7733slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
7734with a star ('*') after the field name below.
7735
7736 Example :
7737 frontend http-in
7738 mode http
7739 option httplog
7740 log global
7741 default_backend bck
7742
7743 backend static
7744 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7745
7746 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7747 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7748 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007749 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007750
7751 Field Format Extract from the example above
7752 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
7753 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
7754 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
7755 4 frontend_name http-in
7756 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
7757 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
7758 7 status_code 200
7759 8 bytes_read* 2750
7760 9 captured_request_cookie -
7761 10 captured_response_cookie -
7762 11 termination_state ----
7763 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
7764 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7765 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
7766 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
7767 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007768
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007769
7770Detailed fields description :
7771 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7772 connection to haproxy.
7773
7774 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7775
7776 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
7777 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
7778 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
7779 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
7780 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
7781
7782 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7783 and processed the connection.
7784
7785 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7786 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7787 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
7788
7789 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7790 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7791 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7792 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
7793 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
7794 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
7795
7796 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
7797 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
7798 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
7799 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
7800 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
7801 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
7802
7803 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7804 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7805 See "Timers" below for more details.
7806
7807 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7808 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7809 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
7810 below for more details.
7811
7812 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
7813 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
7814 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
7815 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
7816 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
7817 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
7818 for more details.
7819
7820 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7821 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7822 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7823 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7824 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7825 details.
7826
7827 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
7828 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
7829 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
7830
7831 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
7832 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
7833 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
7834 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
7835 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
7836 overflowing.
7837
7838 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
7839 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
7840 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
7841 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
7842 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
7843 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
7844 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
7845 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7846
7847 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
7848 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
7849 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
7850 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
7851 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
7852 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
7853 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
7854 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7855
7856 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7857 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7858 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
7859 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
7860 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
7861 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
7862 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
7863
7864 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7865 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7866 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
7867 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
7868 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007869 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007870 system.
7871
7872 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7873 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7874 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7875 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7876 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7877 caused by a denial of service attack.
7878
7879 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7880 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7881 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7882 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7883 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7884 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7885 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7886 denial of service attack.
7887
7888 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7889 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7890 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7891 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7892 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7893 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7894 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7895 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
7896 processed than on other servers.
7897
7898 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7899 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7900 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7901 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7902 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7903 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7904 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7905 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7906 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7907 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7908 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7909 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7910 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7911
7912 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7913 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7914 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7915 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7916 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7917 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7918 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7919 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7920
7921 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7922 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7923 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7924 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7925 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7926 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7927 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7928 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7929 occurs.
7930
7931 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
7932 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
7933 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
7934 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
7935 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
7936 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
7937 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
7938 cookies" below for more details.
7939
7940 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
7941 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
7942 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
7943 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
7944 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
7945 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
7946 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
7947 and cookies" below for more details.
7948
7949 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
7950 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
7951 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
7952 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
7953 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
7954 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
7955 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
7956 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
7957
7958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079598.3. Advanced logging options
7960-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007961
7962Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
7963just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
7964options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
7965for more information about their usage.
7966
7967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079688.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
7969------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007970
7971It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
7972haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
7973commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
7974monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
7975ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
7976
7977 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
7978 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
7979 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
7980 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
7981
7982 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
7983 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
7984 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
7985 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
7986 such as other load-balancers.
7987
7988 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
7989 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
7990 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
7991
7992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079938.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
7994----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007995
7996The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
7997what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
7998or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
7999"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8000just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8001log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8002after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8003is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8004with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8005with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8006
8007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8009------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008010
8011Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8012for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8013"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8014retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8015raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8016a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8017file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8018you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8019"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8020
8021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080228.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8023--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008024
8025Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8026multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8027them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8028"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8029logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8030error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8031and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8032too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8033useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8034alternative.
8035
8036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080378.4. Timing events
8038------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008039
8040Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8041reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8042the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8043frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8044mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8045
8046 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8047 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8048 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8049 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8050 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8051
8052 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8053 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8054 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8055 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8056 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8057
8058 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8059 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8060 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8061 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8062 connection never established.
8063
8064 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8065 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8066 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8067 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8068 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8069 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8070 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8071 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8072 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8073 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8074 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8075
8076 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8077 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8078 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8079 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8080 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8081
8082 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8083
8084 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8085 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8086 negative.
8087
8088These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8089protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8090that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008091due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008092close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8093session has been aborted on timeout.
8094
8095Most common cases :
8096
8097 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8098 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8099 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8100 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8101 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8102 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8103 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8104 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8105 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008106 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8107 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8108 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008109
8110 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8111 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8112 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8113 of ms on remote networks.
8114
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008115 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8116 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8117 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008118
8119 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8120 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8121 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8122 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8123 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8124 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8125 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8126 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8127 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8128 to the server until another one is released.
8129
8130Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8131
8132 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8133 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8134 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8135
8136 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8137 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8138 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8139
8140 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8141 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8142 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8143 flags.
8144
8145 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8146 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8147 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8148 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8149 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8150 the client connection was maintained open.
8151
8152 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8153 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8154 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8155 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8156
8157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081588.5. Session state at disconnection
8159-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008160
8161TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8162"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
81632-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8164each of which has a special meaning :
8165
8166 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8167 session to terminate :
8168
8169 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8170
8171 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8172 server explicitly refused it.
8173
8174 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8175 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8176 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8177 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8178 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8179 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8180
8181 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8182 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8183 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8184 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8185 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8186
8187 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8188 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8189 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8190 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8191 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8192
8193 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8194 send or receive data.
8195
8196 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8197 send or receive data.
8198
8199 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8200 with nothing left in the buffers.
8201
8202 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8203
8204 R : th proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
8205 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8206
8207 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8208 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8209 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8210 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8211 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8212
8213 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8214 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8215
8216 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8217 server (HTTP only).
8218
8219 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8220
8221 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8222 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8223 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8224
8225 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8226 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8227 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8228
8229 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8230
8231 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8232 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8233
8234 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8235 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8236 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8237
8238 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8239 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008240 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8241 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008242
8243 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8244 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8245 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8246 another server.
8247
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008248 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008249 server.
8250
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008251 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8252 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8253 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8254 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8255
8256 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8257 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8258 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8259 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008261 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8262
8263 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8264 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8265
8266 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8267
8268 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8269 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8270 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8271
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008272 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8273 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8274 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8275 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8276 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008278 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8279
8280 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8281 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8282
8283 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8284
8285 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8286
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008287The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8288was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008289helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8290starvation, attacks, etc...
8291
8292The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8293alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8294easier finding and understanding.
8295
8296 Flags Reason
8297
8298 -- Normal termination.
8299
8300 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8301 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8302 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8303 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8304
8305 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8306 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8307 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8308 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8309 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8310 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008311
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008312 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8313 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8314 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8315
8316 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8317 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8318 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8319
8320 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8321 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8322 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8323 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8324 the server takes too long to respond.
8325
8326 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8327 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8328 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8329 long a time to respond.
8330
8331 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8332 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8333 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8334 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8335 and the client.
8336
8337 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8338 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8339 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8340 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8341 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8342 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8343
8344 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8345 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008346 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8347 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8348 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8349 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008351 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008352 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8353 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8354 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8355 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8356 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8357
8358 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8359 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8360 503 or 504 here.
8361
8362 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8363 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8364 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8365 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8366 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8367
8368 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8369 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008370 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008371 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8372 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8373
8374 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8375 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8376 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8377 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8378 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8379 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8380 between haproxy and the server.
8381
8382 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8383 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8384 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8385 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8386 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8387 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8388 solution is to fix the application.
8389
8390 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8391 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8392 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8393 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8394 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8395 external attacks.
8396
8397 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8398 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8399 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8400 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8401 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8402
8403 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8404 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8405 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8406 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8407 containing unauthorized characters.
8408
8409 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8410 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8411 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8412 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8413
8414 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8415 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8416 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8417 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8418
8419 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8420 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8421 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8422 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8423
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008424The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8425persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8426important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8427re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8428
8429 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8430
8431 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8432 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8433 set on a GET request.
8434
8435 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8436 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8437 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8438 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8439
8440 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8441 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8442 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8443
8444 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8445 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8446 already got a cookie.
8447
8448 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8449 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8450 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8451 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8452 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8453
8454 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8455 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8456 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8457
8458 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8459 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8460 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8461
8462 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8463 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8464
8465 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8466 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8467 then advertised in the response.
8468
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084708.6. Non-printable characters
8471-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008472
8473In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8474consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8475converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8476prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8477being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8478escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8479is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8480'}' when logging headers.
8481
8482Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8483issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8484containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8485
8486Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8487the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8488performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8489
8490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8492---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008493
8494Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8495achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008496section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008497cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8498the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8499the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008500locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008501not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8502user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8503a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8504wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8505
8506 Examples :
8507 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8508 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8509
8510 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8511 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8512
8513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8515---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008516
8517Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8518proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8519the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8520server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8521
8522Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8523response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008524section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008525
8526It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008527time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8528appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008529are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8530and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8531follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8532request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8533in the logs.
8534
8535 Example :
8536 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8537 listen proxy-out
8538 mode http
8539 option httplog
8540 option logasap
8541 log global
8542 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8543
8544 # log the name of the virtual server
8545 capture request header Host len 20
8546
8547 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8548 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8549
8550 # log the beginning of the referrer
8551 capture request header Referer len 20
8552
8553 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8554 capture response header Server len 20
8555
8556 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8557 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8558
8559 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8560 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8561
8562 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8563 capture response header Via len 20
8564
8565 # log the URL location during a redirection
8566 capture response header Location len 20
8567
8568 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8569 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8570 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8571 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8572 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8573
8574 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8575 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8576 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8577 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008578 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008579
8580 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8581 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8582 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8583 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8584 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008585 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008586
8587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085888.9. Examples of logs
8589---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008590
8591These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8592them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8593reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8594
8595 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8596 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8597 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8598
8599 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8600 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8601
8602 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8603 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8604 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8605
8606 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8607 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8608
8609 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8610 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8611 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8612
8613 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008614 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008615 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
8616 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
8617
8618 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
8619 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
8620 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
8621
8622 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
8623 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
8624 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
8625 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
8626 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
8627 to return the 502 and not the server.
8628
8629 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008630 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008631
8632 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
8633 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
8634 Nothing was sent to any server.
8635
8636 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
8637 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
8638
8639 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
8640 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
8641 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
8642 send a 408 return code to the client.
8643
8644 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
8645 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
8646
8647 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
8648 5 seconds ("c----").
8649
8650 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
8651 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008652 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008653
8654 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008655 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008656 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
8657 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
8658 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
8659 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
8660 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008661
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086639. Statistics and monitoring
8664----------------------------
8665
8666It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
8667mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
8668CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
8669Unix socket.
8670
8671
86729.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008673---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008674
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01008675The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
8676page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
8677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008678 0. pxname: proxy name
8679 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
8680 for server)
8681 2. qcur: current queued requests
8682 3. qmax: max queued requests
8683 4. scur: current sessions
8684 5. smax: max sessions
8685 6. slim: sessions limit
8686 7. stot: total sessions
8687 8. bin: bytes in
8688 9. bout: bytes out
8689 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008690 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008691 12. ereq: request errors
8692 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008693 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008694 15. wretr: retries (warning)
8695 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01008696 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008697 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
8698 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
8699 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
8700 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
8701 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
8702 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
8703 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
8704 25. qlimit: queue limit
8705 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
8706 27. iid: unique proxy id
8707 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
8708 29. throttle: warm up status
8709 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
8710 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008711 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02008712 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
8713 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
8714 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008715 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008716 UNK -> unknown
8717 INI -> initializing
8718 SOCKERR -> socket error
8719 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
8720 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
8721 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
8722 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
8723 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
8724 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
8725 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
8726 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
8727 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
8728 disable-on-404
8729 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
8730 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
8731 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008732 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
8733 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008734 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
8735 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
8736 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
8737 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
8738 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
8739 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008740 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
8741 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
8742 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
8743 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008744 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
8745 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008746
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087489.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008749-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008750
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008751The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008752must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
8753is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
8754a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
8755risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
8756followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
8757given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
8758then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
8759to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008760
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008761It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
8762on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
8763own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008764
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008765clear counters
8766 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
8767 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
8768 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
8769 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
8770 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8771
8772clear counters all
8773 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
8774 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
8775 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
8776
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008777clear table <table> key <key>
8778 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
8779 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
8780 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
8781 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
8782 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
8783 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
8784 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
8785 usuall enough.
8786
8787 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008788 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8789 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8790 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8791 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8792 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8793 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008794
8795 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8796
8797 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008798 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:1
8799 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8800 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008802disable server <backend>/<server>
8803 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
8804 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
8805 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
8806 during the maintenance.
8807
8808 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
8809 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
8810
8811 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8812 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8813
8814 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8815 level "admin".
8816
8817enable server <backend>/<server>
8818 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
8819 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
8820
8821 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8822 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8823
8824 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8825 level "admin".
8826
8827get weight <backend>/<server>
8828 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
8829 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
8830 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
8831 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
8832 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
8833 dash ('#').
8834
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008835help
8836 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
8837 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008838
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008839prompt
8840 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
8841 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
8842 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
8843 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
8844 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
8845 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
8846 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
8847 command.
8848
8849quit
8850 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008851
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008852set timeout cli <delay>
8853 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
8854 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
8855 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
8856
8857set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
8858 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
8859 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
8860 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
8861 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
8862 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
8863 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
8864 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
8865 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
8866 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
8867 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
8868 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
8869 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
8870 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
8871 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8872
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008873show errors [<iid>]
8874 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
8875 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008876 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
8877 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
8878 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008879
8880 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
8881 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
8882 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
8883 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
8884 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
8885 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
8886 are reported too.
8887
8888 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
8889 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
8890 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
8891 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
8892 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
8893 code.
8894
8895 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
8896 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
8897 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
8898 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
8899 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
8900 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
8901 line.
8902
8903 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008904 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8905 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008906 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
8907 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
8908
8909 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
8910 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
8911 00038 Location: blah\r\n
8912 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
8913 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
8914 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
8915 00204+ minal\r\n
8916 00211 \r\n
8917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008918 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008919 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
8920 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
8921 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
8922 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
8923 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
8924 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008925
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008926show info
8927 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
8928
8929show sess
8930 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008931 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
8932 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8933
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01008934show sess <id>
8935 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
8936 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
8937 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
8938 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
8939 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
8940 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008941
8942show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
8943 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
8944 possible to dump only selected items :
8945 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
8946 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
8947 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
8948 for example:
8949 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
8950 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
8951 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
8952
8953 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008954 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
8955 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008956 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
8957 Release_date: 2009/09/23
8958 Nbproc: 1
8959 Process_num: 1
8960 (...)
8961
8962 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
8963 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
8964 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
8965 (...)
8966 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
8967
8968 $
8969
8970 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
8971 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
8972 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
8973 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008974 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008975
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008976show table
8977 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
8978 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
8979 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
8980 entries currently in use.
8981
8982 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008983 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8984 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
8985 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008986
8987show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
8988 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
8989 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
8990 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
8991 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
8992 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
8993 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
8994 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
8995 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
8996 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
8997 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
8998 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
8999 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9000 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9001 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9002
9003 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009004 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9005 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9006 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9007 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9008 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9009 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009010
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009011 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9012 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9013 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9014 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009015
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009016 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9017 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9018 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9019 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9020 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009021
9022 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9023 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9024 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9025 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9026 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9027
9028 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9029 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9030 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009031 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9032 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009033 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9034 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009036/*
9037 * Local variables:
9038 * fill-column: 79
9039 * End:
9040 */